binutils: readelf: support CTF dicts with non-native-endian symtabs
[binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @setfilename ld.info
3 @c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @syncodeindex ky cp
5 @c man begin INCLUDE
6 @include configdoc.texi
7 @c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
8 @include bfdver.texi
9 @c man end
10
11 @c @smallbook
12
13 @macro gcctabopt{body}
14 @code{\body\}
15 @end macro
16
17 @c man begin NAME
18 @ifset man
19 @c Configure for the generation of man pages
20 @set UsesEnvVars
21 @set GENERIC
22 @set ARM
23 @set C6X
24 @set CSKY
25 @set H8300
26 @set HPPA
27 @set M68HC11
28 @set M68K
29 @set MIPS
30 @set MMIX
31 @set MSP430
32 @set NDS32
33 @set NIOSII
34 @set PDP11
35 @set POWERPC
36 @set POWERPC64
37 @set Renesas
38 @set S/390
39 @set SPU
40 @set TICOFF
41 @set WIN32
42 @set XTENSA
43 @end ifset
44 @c man end
45
46 @ifnottex
47 @dircategory Software development
48 @direntry
49 * Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
50 @end direntry
51 @end ifnottex
52
53 @copying
54 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57 @end ifset
58 version @value{VERSION}.
59
60 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
61
62 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
63 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
64 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
67 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
68 @end copying
69 @iftex
70 @finalout
71 @setchapternewpage odd
72 @settitle The GNU linker
73 @titlepage
74 @title The GNU linker
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @code{ld}
77 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79 @end ifset
80 @subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81 @author Steve Chamberlain
82 @author Ian Lance Taylor
83 @page
84
85 @tex
86 {\parskip=0pt
87 \hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88 \hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
89 \hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
90 \hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91 }
92 \global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
97 Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
98
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
101 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102 with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103 Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
104 section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
105 @c man end
106
107 @end titlepage
108 @end iftex
109 @contents
110 @c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top
114 @top LD
115 This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118 @end ifset
119 version @value{VERSION}.
120
121 This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
122 Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123 in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
124
125 @menu
126 * Overview:: Overview
127 * Invocation:: Invocation
128 * Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129 @ifset GENERIC
130 * Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131 @end ifset
132 @ifclear GENERIC
133 @ifset H8300
134 * H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135 @end ifset
136 @ifset Renesas
137 * Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
138 @end ifset
139 @ifset ARM
140 * ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141 @end ifset
142 @ifset M68HC11
143 * M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144 @end ifset
145 @ifset HPPA
146 * HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147 @end ifset
148 @ifset M68K
149 * M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150 @end ifset
151 @ifset MIPS
152 * MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153 @end ifset
154 @ifset POWERPC
155 * PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156 @end ifset
157 @ifset POWERPC64
158 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159 @end ifset
160 @ifset S/390
161 * S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162 @end ifset
163 @ifset SPU
164 * SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165 @end ifset
166 @ifset TICOFF
167 * TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168 @end ifset
169 @ifset WIN32
170 * Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171 @end ifset
172 @ifset XTENSA
173 * Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174 @end ifset
175 @end ifclear
176 @ifclear SingleFormat
177 * BFD:: BFD
178 @end ifclear
179 @c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181 * Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182 * MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
183 * GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
184 * LD Index:: LD Index
185 @end menu
186 @end ifnottex
187
188 @node Overview
189 @chapter Overview
190
191 @cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192 @cindex what is this?
193
194 @ifset man
195 @c man begin SYNOPSIS
196 ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
197 @c man end
198
199 @c man begin SEEALSO
200 ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201 the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202 @file{ld}.
203 @c man end
204 @end ifset
205
206 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
208 @command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
209 their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
210 compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
211
212 @command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
213 a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214 to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
216 @ifset man
217 @c For the man only
218 This man page does not describe the command language; see the
219 @command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220 language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
221 @end ifset
222
223 @ifclear SingleFormat
224 This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225 to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
226 write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227 @code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228 available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229 @end ifclear
230
231 Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232 linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233 execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
234 @command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
235 (or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
237 @c man end
238
239 @node Invocation
240 @chapter Invocation
241
242 @c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
244 The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
245 and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246 you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
248 @c man end
249
250 @ifset UsesEnvVars
251 @menu
252 * Options:: Command-line Options
253 * Environment:: Environment Variables
254 @end menu
255
256 @node Options
257 @section Command-line Options
258 @end ifset
259
260 @cindex command line
261 @cindex options
262
263 @c man begin OPTIONS
264
265 The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266 practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267 @cindex standard Unix system
268 For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
269 object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270 link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272 @smallexample
273 ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274 @end smallexample
275
276 This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
277 result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278 the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279 directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
281 Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
282 point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283 as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284 which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285 files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286 different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
287 occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288 option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289 noted in the descriptions below.
290
291 @cindex object files
292 Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293 together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294 options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295 an option and its argument.
296
297 Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298 specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299 and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300 are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301 message @samp{No input files}.
302
303 If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
304 assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305 augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306 linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307 permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308 or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
309 @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310 script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311 extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312 to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313 the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
314
315 For options whose names are a single letter,
316 option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317 whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318 option that requires them.
319
320 For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
321 precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
322 @samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
323 this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
324 only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
325 @samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326 name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327 output.
328
329 Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330 option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331 immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332 @samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333 Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334 accepted.
335
336 Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
337 (e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
338 prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339 compiler driver) like this:
340
341 @smallexample
342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
343 @end smallexample
344
345 This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
346 silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347 may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348 driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349 a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350 and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351 the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353 @smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355 @end smallexample
356
357 Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
358 linker:
359
360 @table @gcctabopt
361 @include at-file.texi
362
363 @kindex -a @var{keyword}
364 @item -a @var{keyword}
365 This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366 argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367 @samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368 @samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369 to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
371 @kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372 @item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377 finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
378 it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
379 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
380 interface.
381
382 @ifclear SingleFormat
383 @cindex binary input format
384 @kindex -b @var{format}
385 @kindex --format=@var{format}
386 @cindex input format
387 @cindex input format
388 @item -b @var{input-format}
389 @itemx --format=@var{input-format}
390 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
392 @samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
393 that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
394 configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
395 to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
396 default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397 @var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398 supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399 formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400 @xref{BFD}.
401
402 You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403 binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404 linking object files of different formats), by including
405 @samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
406 particular format.
407
408 The default format is taken from the environment variable
409 @code{GNUTARGET}.
410 @ifset UsesEnvVars
411 @xref{Environment}.
412 @end ifset
413 You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
414 @code{TARGET};
415 @ifclear man
416 see @ref{Format Commands}.
417 @end ifclear
418 @end ifclear
419
420 @kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421 @kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422 @cindex compatibility, MRI
423 @item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424 @itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
425 For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
426 files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
427 @ifclear man
428 @ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429 @end ifclear
430 @ifset man
431 the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432 @end ifset
433 Introduce MRI script files with
434 the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
435 scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436 If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
437 specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439 @cindex common allocation
440 @kindex -d
441 @kindex -dc
442 @kindex -dp
443 @item -d
444 @itemx -dc
445 @itemx -dp
446 These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447 compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448 even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449 script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
452 @kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453 @kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454 @item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455 @itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456 Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457 @var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458 specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459 will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460 option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
461 The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
462
463 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465 This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466 fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467 section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468 error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469 several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470 section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471 sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473 @smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492 @end smallexample
493
494 This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495 the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497 @kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498 @item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499 This option enables warnings when
500 @code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501 matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502 discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503 output region.
504
505 @cindex entry point, from command line
506 @kindex -e @var{entry}
507 @kindex --entry=@var{entry}
508 @item -e @var{entry}
509 @itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510 Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511 program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512 named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513 and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514 base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515 @samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516 and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
518 @kindex --exclude-libs
519 @item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520 Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
521 exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
522 @code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523 automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524 port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525 explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526 option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527 be treated as hidden.
528
529 @kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531 Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532 should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533 into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534 may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535 used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536 the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537 match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538 command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539 of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540 regardless of this option.
541
542 @cindex dynamic symbol table
543 @kindex -E
544 @kindex --export-dynamic
545 @kindex --no-export-dynamic
546 @item -E
547 @itemx --export-dynamic
548 @itemx --no-export-dynamic
549 When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550 option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551 all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552 set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554 If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555 @option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556 dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557 referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
558
559 If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560 back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561 dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562 linking the program itself.
563
564 You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
565 be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
566 See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
567
568 Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569 support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570 the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
572 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573 @cindex export dynamic symbol
574 @item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575 When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576 @var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577 shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578 bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579 no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580 @samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581 on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583 @kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584 @cindex export dynamic symbol list
585 @item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586 Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587 The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
590 @ifclear SingleFormat
591 @cindex big-endian objects
592 @cindex endianness
593 @kindex -EB
594 @item -EB
595 Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597 @cindex little-endian objects
598 @kindex -EL
599 @item -EL
600 Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
601 @end ifclear
602
603 @kindex -f @var{name}
604 @kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605 @item -f @var{name}
606 @itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
607 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608 to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609 table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610 symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614 the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615 first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616 @var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617 in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618 Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619 implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
620 machine-specific performance.
621
622 This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623 will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
625 @kindex -F @var{name}
626 @kindex --filter=@var{name}
627 @item -F @var{name}
628 @itemx --filter=@var{name}
629 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630 the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631 of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632 on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634 If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635 run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636 dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637 filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638 found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639 used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640 @var{name}.
641
642 Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
643 toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
644 object files.
645 @ifclear SingleFormat
646 The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
647 @option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
648 @code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
649 environment variable.
650 @end ifclear
651 The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652 creating an ELF shared object.
653
654 @cindex finalization function
655 @kindex -fini=@var{name}
656 @item -fini=@var{name}
657 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658 executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659 address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660 the function to call.
661
662 @kindex -g
663 @item -g
664 Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
666 @kindex -G @var{value}
667 @kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
668 @cindex object size
669 @item -G @var{value}
670 @itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671 Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672 @var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
673 MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
674 sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676 @cindex runtime library name
677 @kindex -h @var{name}
678 @kindex -soname=@var{name}
679 @item -h @var{name}
680 @itemx -soname=@var{name}
681 When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682 the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683 which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684 linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685 field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687 @kindex -i
688 @cindex incremental link
689 @item -i
690 Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
692 @cindex initialization function
693 @kindex -init=@var{name}
694 @item -init=@var{name}
695 When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696 executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697 of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698 function to call.
699
700 @cindex archive files, from cmd line
701 @kindex -l @var{namespec}
702 @kindex --library=@var{namespec}
703 @item -l @var{namespec}
704 @itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705 Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706 list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707 If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
708 will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
709 will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
710
711 On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
712 files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713 and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714 called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715 @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716 indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717 to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718 @var{filename}.
719
720 The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721 specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722 was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723 command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724 archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725 the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
727 See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
728 archives multiple times.
729
730 You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732 @ifset GENERIC
733 This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
734 if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
735 behaviour of the AIX linker.
736 @end ifset
737
738 @cindex search directory, from cmd line
739 @kindex -L @var{dir}
740 @kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
741 @item -L @var{searchdir}
742 @itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
743 Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744 for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
745 option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746 in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747 on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
748 @option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
749 order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750 how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751 option is specified.
752
753 If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754 prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755 @samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
756
757 @ifset UsesEnvVars
758 The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
759 @samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
760 some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761 @end ifset
762
763 The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764 @code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765 at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767 @cindex emulation
768 @kindex -m @var{emulation}
769 @item -m @var{emulation}
770 Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771 emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773 If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774 @code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776 Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777 configured.
778
779 @cindex link map
780 @kindex -M
781 @kindex --print-map
782 @item -M
783 @itemx --print-map
784 Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785 information about the link, including the following:
786
787 @itemize @bullet
788 @item
789 Where object files are mapped into memory.
790 @item
791 How common symbols are allocated.
792 @item
793 All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794 which caused the archive member to be brought in.
795 @item
796 The values assigned to symbols.
797
798 Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799 involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800 have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801 linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802 of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803 the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804 linker script containing:
805
806 @smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810 @end smallexample
811
812 will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813 option is used:
814
815 @smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819 @end smallexample
820
821 See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822 scripts.
823
824 @item
825 How GNU properties are merged.
826
827 When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828 .note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829 These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
830
831 @smallexample
832 Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833 @end smallexample
834
835 This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
836 merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839 @smallexample
840 Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
841 @end smallexample
842
843 This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
844 when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845 is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
846 @end itemize
847
848 @cindex link map discarded
849 @kindex --print-map-discarded
850 @kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851 @item --print-map-discarded
852 @itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853 Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854 in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
856 @kindex -n
857 @cindex read-only text
858 @cindex NMAGIC
859 @kindex --nmagic
860 @item -n
861 @itemx --nmagic
862 Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864 mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
865
866 @kindex -N
867 @kindex --omagic
868 @cindex read/write from cmd line
869 @cindex OMAGIC
870 @item -N
871 @itemx --omagic
872 Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
873 not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874 libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
875 mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876 is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877 specification published by Microsoft.
878
879 @kindex --no-omagic
880 @cindex OMAGIC
881 @item --no-omagic
882 This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883 sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884 be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885 shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
886
887 @kindex -o @var{output}
888 @kindex --output=@var{output}
889 @cindex naming the output file
890 @item -o @var{output}
891 @itemx --output=@var{output}
892 Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
893 option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894 script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
896 @kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897 @cindex dependency file
898 @item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899 Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900 suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901 that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902 output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903 Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904 Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905 to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906 linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907 @samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908 installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909 distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
911 @kindex -O @var{level}
912 @cindex generating optimized output
913 @item -O @var{level}
914 If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
915 the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
916 should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917 option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918 the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919 no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920 of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
921
922 @kindex -plugin @var{name}
923 @item -plugin @var{name}
924 Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925 the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926 automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927 optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928 wish.
929
930 Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931 from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932 @command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933 those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
934 copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
935 based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
936 just copy in the newest one.
937
938 @kindex --push-state
939 @cindex push state governing input file handling
940 @item --push-state
941 The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942 flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943 restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945 The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946 @option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947 @option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948 @option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949 @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950 @option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952 One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953 used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954 listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955 something as follows:
956
957 @smallexample
958 -Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959 @end smallexample
960
961 @kindex --pop-state
962 @cindex pop state governing input file handling
963 @item --pop-state
964 Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965 flags governing input file handling.
966
967 @kindex -q
968 @kindex --emit-relocs
969 @cindex retain relocations in final executable
970 @item -q
971 @itemx --emit-relocs
972 Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
973 Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974 order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975 in larger executables.
976
977 This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
979 @kindex --force-dynamic
980 @cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981 @item --force-dynamic
982 Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983 to VxWorks targets.
984
985 @cindex partial link
986 @cindex relocatable output
987 @kindex -r
988 @kindex --relocatable
989 @item -r
990 @itemx --relocatable
991 Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
992 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
993 linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994 magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995 @code{OMAGIC}.
996 @c ; see @option{-N}.
997 If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998 linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999 constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
1001 When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002 partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003 relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004 example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005 with input files in other formats at all.
1006
1007 This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009 @kindex -R @var{file}
1010 @kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011 @cindex symbol-only input
1012 @item -R @var{filename}
1013 @itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014 Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015 relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016 to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017 programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
1019 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
1020 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
1021 the @option{-rpath} option.
1022
1023 @kindex -s
1024 @kindex --strip-all
1025 @cindex strip all symbols
1026 @item -s
1027 @itemx --strip-all
1028 Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030 @kindex -S
1031 @kindex --strip-debug
1032 @cindex strip debugger symbols
1033 @item -S
1034 @itemx --strip-debug
1035 Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
1037 @kindex --strip-discarded
1038 @kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039 @item --strip-discarded
1040 @itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041 Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042 Enabled by default.
1043
1044 @kindex -t
1045 @kindex --trace
1046 @cindex input files, displaying
1047 @item -t
1048 @itemx --trace
1049 Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050 @samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051 @samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052 and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053 a linker bug report.
1054
1055 @kindex -T @var{script}
1056 @kindex --script=@var{script}
1057 @cindex script files
1058 @item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059 @itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060 Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
1061 @command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
1062 @var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
1063 output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064 the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065 specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066 options accumulate.
1067
1068 @kindex -dT @var{script}
1069 @kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070 @cindex script files
1071 @item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072 @itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073 Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075 This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076 processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077 command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078 @option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079 behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080 command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081 the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082 @samp{gcc}).
1083
1084 @kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085 @kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086 @cindex undefined symbol
1087 @item -u @var{symbol}
1088 @itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091 modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092 different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093 option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
1095 If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096 into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097 undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098 instead.
1099
1100 @kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101 @cindex symbols, require defined
1102 @cindex defined symbol
1103 @item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104 Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105 is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106 is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107 and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108 @code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109 can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
1111 @kindex -Ur
1112 @cindex constructors
1113 @item -Ur
1114 For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115 @samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
1116 turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
1117 @emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118 It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119 with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120 be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121 @samp{-r} for the others.
1122
1123 @kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124 @cindex orphan sections
1125 @cindex sections, orphan
1126 @item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127 Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128 specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130 @var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132 @table @code
1133 @item place
1134 Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135 the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
1136 @samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
1137
1138 @item discard
1139 All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140 @samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142 @item warn
1143 The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144 issue a warning.
1145
1146 @item error
1147 The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148 @end table
1149
1150 The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
1152 @kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153 @item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154 Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155 @var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156 missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157 specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158 multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159 input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160 in a linker script.
1161
1162 @kindex -v
1163 @kindex -V
1164 @kindex --version
1165 @cindex version
1166 @item -v
1167 @itemx --version
1168 @itemx -V
1169 Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
1170 lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172 @kindex -x
1173 @kindex --discard-all
1174 @cindex deleting local symbols
1175 @item -x
1176 @itemx --discard-all
1177 Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179 @kindex -X
1180 @kindex --discard-locals
1181 @cindex local symbols, deleting
1182 @item -X
1183 @itemx --discard-locals
1184 Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185 system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186 or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
1187
1188 @kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189 @kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190 @cindex symbol tracing
1191 @item -y @var{symbol}
1192 @itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193 Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194 option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195 to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197 This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198 don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200 @kindex -Y @var{path}
1201 @item -Y @var{path}
1202 Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203 for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205 @kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206 @item -z @var{keyword}
1207 The recognized keywords are:
1208 @table @samp
1209
1210 @item bndplt
1211 Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213 @item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214 @itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215 @itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216 @itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217 Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218 to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219 @option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220 @option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221 @option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222 @option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223 Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
1225 @item cet-report=none
1226 @itemx cet-report=warning
1227 @itemx cet-report=error
1228 Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230 section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231 linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232 @option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233 missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234 the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235 Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236 GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237 turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
1240 @item combreloc
1241 @itemx nocombreloc
1242 Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243 dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
1244
1245 @item common
1246 @itemx nocommon
1247 Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248 link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250 @item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251 Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252 layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253 using pages of this size.
1254
1255 @item defs
1256 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
1259
1260 @item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261 @itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262 Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263 if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264 by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265 @samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266 may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267 selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268 these options.
1269
1270 @item execstack
1271 Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
1273 @item global
1274 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275 the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276 of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
1278 @item globalaudit
1279 This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280 This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281 setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282 tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
1283 the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
1284 all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
1285
1286 @item ibtplt
1287 Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
1290 @item ibt
1291 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292 to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
1295 @item initfirst
1296 This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297 It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298 before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299 the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300 the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301 objects.
1302
1303 @item interpose
1304 Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305 so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306 libraries not so marked.
1307
1308 @item lazy
1309 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310 dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311 the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312 Lazy binding is the default.
1313
1314 @item loadfltr
1315 Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
1316
1317 @item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318 Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
1319
1320 @item muldefs
1321 Allow multiple definitions.
1322
1323 @item nocopyreloc
1324 Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325 defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
1326
1327 @item nodefaultlib
1328 Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329 should ignore any default library search paths.
1330
1331 @item nodelete
1332 Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
1333
1334 @item nodlopen
1335 Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
1336
1337 @item nodump
1338 Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
1339
1340 @item noexecstack
1341 Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
1343 @item noextern-protected-data
1344 Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345 library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346 used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347 generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348 module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349 i386 and x86-64.
1350
1351 @item noreloc-overflow
1352 Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353 relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354 overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
1355
1356 @item now
1357 When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358 dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
1359 when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360 function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361 called.
1362
1363 @item origin
1364 Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
1365
1366 @item relro
1367 @itemx norelro
1368 Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369 specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370 relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371 than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
1372 Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
1373
1374 @item separate-code
1375 @itemx noseparate-code
1376 Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377 specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378 be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379 code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
1381 @item unique-symbol
1382 @itemx nounique-symbol
1383 Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1384 ".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1385 is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1386
1387 @item shstk
1388 Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1389 to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1390 Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1391
1392 @item stack-size=@var{value}
1393 Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
1394 Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1395 @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1396
1397 @item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1398 @cindex visibility
1399 @cindex ELF symbol visibility
1400 Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1401 @code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1402 Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1403 @samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1404 start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1405 compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1406 recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1407 programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1408 between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1409
1410 @item text
1411 @itemx notext
1412 @itemx textoff
1413 Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1414 or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1415 report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
1416
1417 @item undefs
1418 Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1419 either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1420 This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1421
1422 @item x86-64-baseline
1423 @item x86-64-v2
1424 @item x86-64-v3
1425 @itemx x86-64-v4
1426 Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
1427 @option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
1428 @option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1429 @option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1430 @option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1431 Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1432
1433 @end table
1434
1435 Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
1436
1437 @kindex -(
1438 @cindex groups of archives
1439 @item -( @var{archives} -)
1440 @itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1441 The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1442 either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1443
1444 The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1445 references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1446 the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1447 archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1448 object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1449 would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
1450 they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
1451 resolved.
1452
1453 Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1454 it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1455 more archives.
1456
1457 @kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1458 @kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1459 @item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1460 @itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1461 Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
1462 recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
1463 and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1464 the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1465 behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1466 so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1467 restore the old behaviour.
1468
1469 @kindex --as-needed
1470 @kindex --no-as-needed
1471 @item --as-needed
1472 @itemx --no-as-needed
1473 This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
1474 on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
1475 the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1476 on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
1477 needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
1478 emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1479 non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1480 the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1481 non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
1482 Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1483 the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1484 needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1485 from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
1486
1487 @kindex --add-needed
1488 @kindex --no-add-needed
1489 @item --add-needed
1490 @itemx --no-add-needed
1491 These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1492 their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1493 options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1494 and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1495
1496 @kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1497 @item -assert @var{keyword}
1498 This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1499
1500 @kindex -Bdynamic
1501 @kindex -dy
1502 @kindex -call_shared
1503 @item -Bdynamic
1504 @itemx -dy
1505 @itemx -call_shared
1506 Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1507 for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1508 default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1509 for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1510 multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
1511 @option{-l} options which follow it.
1512
1513 @kindex -Bgroup
1514 @item -Bgroup
1515 Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1516 section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1517 object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
1518 @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1519 only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
1520
1521 @kindex -Bstatic
1522 @kindex -dn
1523 @kindex -non_shared
1524 @kindex -static
1525 @item -Bstatic
1526 @itemx -dn
1527 @itemx -non_shared
1528 @itemx -static
1529 Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1530 platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1531 variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1532 may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
1533 library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
1534 option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1535 option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1536 shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1537 references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
1538 libraries.
1539
1540 @kindex -Bsymbolic
1541 @item -Bsymbolic
1542 When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1543 definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1544 for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1545 within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1546 platforms which support shared libraries.
1547
1548 @kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1549 @item -Bsymbolic-functions
1550 When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
1551 symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
1552 This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1553 libraries.
1554
1555 @kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1556 @item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1557 Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1558 typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1559 global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1560 within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1561 to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1562 in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1563 which support shared libraries.
1564
1565 The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1566 scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1567
1568 @kindex --dynamic-list-data
1569 @item --dynamic-list-data
1570 Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1571
1572 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1573 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1574 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1575 is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1576
1577 @kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1578 @item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1579 Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1580
1581 @kindex --check-sections
1582 @kindex --no-check-sections
1583 @item --check-sections
1584 @itemx --no-check-sections
1585 Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
1586 been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
1587 perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1588 suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1589 allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
1590 restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
1591 Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1592 force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1593 option.
1594
1595 @kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1596 @kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1597 @item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1598 @itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1599 This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
1600 by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
1601 command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
1602 output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
1603 input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1604 specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
1605 follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1606 behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
1607
1608 This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
1609 libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1610 mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1611 their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1612 required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1613 the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1614 dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
1615 symbols.
1616
1617 @cindex cross reference table
1618 @kindex --cref
1619 @item --cref
1620 Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1621 generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1622 Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1623
1624 The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1625 easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1626 sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1627 symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
1628 definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1629 where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1630 symbol are listed.
1631
1632 @cindex ctf variables
1633 @kindex --ctf-variables
1634 @kindex --no-ctf-variables
1635 @item --ctf-variables
1636 @item --no-ctf-variables
1637 The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1638 types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1639 table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1640 conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1641 usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1642 @option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1643 The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1644
1645 @cindex ctf type sharing
1646 @kindex --ctf-share-types
1647 @item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1648 Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1649
1650 @table @samp
1651 @item share-unconflicted
1652 Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1653 where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1654 translation unit. This is the default.
1655
1656 @item share-duplicated
1657 Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1658 dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1659 dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1660 always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1661 larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1662 large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1663 consumer at runtime.
1664 @end table
1665
1666 @cindex common allocation
1667 @kindex --no-define-common
1668 @item --no-define-common
1669 This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1670 The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1671 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1672
1673 The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1674 the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1675 of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1676 forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1677 Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1678 from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1679 This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1680 and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1681 duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1682 paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1683
1684 @cindex group allocation in linker script
1685 @cindex section groups
1686 @cindex COMDAT
1687 @kindex --force-group-allocation
1688 @item --force-group-allocation
1689 This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1690 normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1691 default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1692 change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1693 command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1694 effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1695
1696 @cindex symbols, from command line
1697 @kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1698 @item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
1699 Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1700 address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1701 times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1702 limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1703 context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1704 symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1705 constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
1706 using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1707 @emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1708 equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
1709
1710 The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1711 in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1712 symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1713 placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1714 the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1715 consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1716 @samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1717 you are trying to achieve.
1718
1719 @cindex demangling, from command line
1720 @kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
1721 @kindex --no-demangle
1722 @item --demangle[=@var{style}]
1723 @itemx --no-demangle
1724 These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1725 and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1726 present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1727 underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
1728 mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1729 different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1730 to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
1731 demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1732 is set. These options may be used to override the default.
1733
1734 @cindex dynamic linker, from command line
1735 @kindex -I@var{file}
1736 @kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1737 @item -I@var{file}
1738 @itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1739 Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1740 generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1741 linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1742 doing.
1743
1744 @kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1745 @item --no-dynamic-linker
1746 When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1747 linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1748 executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1749 entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1750
1751 @kindex --embedded-relocs
1752 @item --embedded-relocs
1753 This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
1754 that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
1755 is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1756 targets.
1757
1758 @kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1759 @item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1760 Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1761 in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1762
1763 @kindex --fatal-warnings
1764 @kindex --no-fatal-warnings
1765 @item --fatal-warnings
1766 @itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1767 Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1768 with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
1769
1770 @kindex --force-exe-suffix
1771 @item --force-exe-suffix
1772 Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1773
1774 If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1775 @code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1776 the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1777 option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1778 Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1779 it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1780
1781 @kindex --gc-sections
1782 @kindex --no-gc-sections
1783 @cindex garbage collection
1784 @item --gc-sections
1785 @itemx --no-gc-sections
1786 Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
1787 targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
1788 performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
1789 @samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1790 collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1791 implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
1792
1793 @samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1794 examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1795 symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1796 command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1797 referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1798 libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1799 referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1800 the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
1801 relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1802 @samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
1803
1804 This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
1805 @samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
1806 specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1807 @samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1808 command in the linker script.
1809
1810 As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1811 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1812
1813 @kindex --print-gc-sections
1814 @kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1815 @cindex garbage collection
1816 @item --print-gc-sections
1817 @itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1818 List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1819 printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1820 collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1821 default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1822 be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1823 line.
1824
1825 @kindex --gc-keep-exported
1826 @cindex garbage collection
1827 @item --gc-keep-exported
1828 When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1829 collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1830 default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1831 executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1832 collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1833 Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1834 it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1835 ELF format targets.
1836
1837 @kindex --print-output-format
1838 @cindex output format
1839 @item --print-output-format
1840 Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1841 other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1842 in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1843
1844 @kindex --print-memory-usage
1845 @cindex memory usage
1846 @item --print-memory-usage
1847 Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1848 the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1849 quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1850 headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1851 parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1855 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1856 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1857 @end smallexample
1858
1859 @cindex help
1860 @cindex usage
1861 @kindex --help
1862 @item --help
1863 Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1864
1865 @kindex --target-help
1866 @item --target-help
1867 Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
1868
1869 @kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1870 @item -Map=@var{mapfile}
1871 Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
1872 @option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1873 @code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1874
1875 Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1876 written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1877 inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1878 file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1879 @code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1880 output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1881 @var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1882
1883 @smallexample
1884 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1885 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1886 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1887 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1888 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1889 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1890 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1891 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1892 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1893 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1894 @end smallexample
1895
1896 It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1897
1898 If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1899 operation.
1900
1901 @cindex memory usage
1902 @kindex --no-keep-memory
1903 @item --no-keep-memory
1904 @command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1905 symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
1906 instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
1907 necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
1908 while linking a large executable.
1909
1910 @kindex --no-undefined
1911 @kindex -z defs
1912 @kindex -z undefs
1913 @item --no-undefined
1914 @itemx -z defs
1915 Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1916 is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1917 The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1918 behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
1919 libraries being linked in.
1920
1921 The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1922
1923 @kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1924 @kindex -z muldefs
1925 @item --allow-multiple-definition
1926 @itemx -z muldefs
1927 Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1928 report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1929 first definition will be used.
1930
1931 @kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
1932 @kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
1933 @item --allow-shlib-undefined
1934 @itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
1935 Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
1936 This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1937 determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1938 shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1939 how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1940
1941 The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1942 referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1943 an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1944 a shared library.
1945
1946 The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1947 libraries specified at link time are that:
1948
1949 @itemize @bullet
1950 @item
1951 A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1952 that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1953 resolvable at load time.
1954 @item
1955 There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1956 symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1957
1958 The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1959 select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1960 architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1961 appropriate memset function.
1962 @end itemize
1963
1964 @kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1965 @item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1966 If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
1967 @var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
1968 only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
1969 libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
1970 ``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
1971 undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
1972 will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
1973 might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
1974 error message will be displayed.
1975
1976 The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
1977 switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
1978
1979 @kindex --no-undefined-version
1980 @item --no-undefined-version
1981 Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1982 it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1983 will be issued instead.
1984
1985 @kindex --default-symver
1986 @item --default-symver
1987 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1988 exported symbols.
1989
1990 @kindex --default-imported-symver
1991 @item --default-imported-symver
1992 Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1993 imported symbols.
1994
1995 @kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1996 @item --no-warn-mismatch
1997 Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
1998 files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1999 been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
2000 This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
2001 errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2002 have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2003 inappropriate.
2004
2005 @kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2006 @item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2007 Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2008 library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2009
2010 @kindex --no-whole-archive
2011 @item --no-whole-archive
2012 Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
2013 archive files.
2014
2015 @cindex output file after errors
2016 @kindex --noinhibit-exec
2017 @item --noinhibit-exec
2018 Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2019 Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2020 errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2021 when it issues any error whatsoever.
2022
2023 @kindex -nostdlib
2024 @item -nostdlib
2025 Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2026 command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2027 (including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2028
2029 @ifclear SingleFormat
2030 @kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2031 @item --oformat=@var{output-format}
2032 @command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2033 file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
2034 @samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
2035 object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2036 object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
2037 should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2038 usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2039 name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2040 list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2041 command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2042 this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2043 @end ifclear
2044
2045 @kindex --out-implib
2046 @item --out-implib @var{file}
2047 Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2048 the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2049 library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2050 may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2051 behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2052 step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2053 the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2054
2055 @kindex -pie
2056 @kindex --pic-executable
2057 @item -pie
2058 @itemx --pic-executable
2059 @cindex position independent executables
2060 Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2061 ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2062 libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
2063 address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
2064 normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2065 defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2066
2067 @kindex -qmagic
2068 @item -qmagic
2069 This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2070
2071 @kindex -Qy
2072 @item -Qy
2073 This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2074
2075 @kindex --relax
2076 @cindex synthesizing linker
2077 @cindex relaxing addressing modes
2078 @cindex --no-relax
2079 @item --relax
2080 @itemx --no-relax
2081 An option with machine dependent effects.
2082 @ifset GENERIC
2083 This option is only supported on a few targets.
2084 @end ifset
2085 @ifset H8300
2086 @xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
2087 @end ifset
2088 @ifset XTENSA
2089 @xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2090 @end ifset
2091 @ifset M68HC11
2092 @xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2093 @end ifset
2094 @ifset NIOSII
2095 @xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2096 @end ifset
2097 @ifset POWERPC
2098 @xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2099 @end ifset
2100
2101 On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
2102 global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2103 addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2104 synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
2105 instructions, and combining constant values.
2106
2107 On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2108 debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2109 @ifset GENERIC
2110 This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2111 family of processors.
2112 @end ifset
2113
2114 On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2115 @option{--no-relax} will disable it.
2116
2117 On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2118 and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2119
2120 @cindex retaining specified symbols
2121 @cindex stripping all but some symbols
2122 @cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2123 @kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2124 @item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2125 Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2126 discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2127 symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2128 @ifset GENERIC
2129 (such as VxWorks)
2130 @end ifset
2131 where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2132 run-time memory.
2133
2134 @samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2135 or symbols needed for relocations.
2136
2137 You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2138 line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2139
2140 @ifset GENERIC
2141 @item -rpath=@var{dir}
2142 @cindex runtime library search path
2143 @kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
2144 Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
2145 linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
2146 arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
2147 them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2148
2149 The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2150 are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2151 description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2152 in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2153 have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2154
2155 If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2156 contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2157 is defined.
2158
2159 The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
2160 SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
2161 @option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2162 runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2163 options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2164 gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
2165 file systems.
2166
2167 For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
2168 followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
2169 the @option{-rpath} option.
2170 @end ifset
2171
2172 @ifset GENERIC
2173 @cindex link-time runtime library search path
2174 @kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2175 @item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2176 When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2177 happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2178 of the input files.
2179
2180 When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2181 non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2182 shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
2183 explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
2184 specifies the first set of directories to search. The
2185 @option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
2186 either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2187 appearing multiple times.
2188
2189 The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2190 directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2191 containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2192 and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
2193 64-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2194
2195 The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2196 @var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2197 supported.
2198
2199 This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2200 that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2201 is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2202 runtime linker would do.
2203
2204 The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
2205 libraries:
2206
2207 @enumerate
2208 @item
2209 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
2210 @item
2211 Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2212 between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2213 specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2214 used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
2215 at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2216 by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2217 the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2218 @item
2219 On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2220 @option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2221 environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
2222 @item
2223 On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2224 directories specified using @option{-L} options.
2225 @item
2226 For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
2227 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
2228 @item
2229 For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2230 @code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2231 libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2232 @code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2233 @item
2234 The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2235 @item
2236 For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2237 exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2238 to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2239 defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2240 configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2241 @item
2242 For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2243 the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2244 header file.
2245 @item
2246 Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2247 linker script being used.
2248 @end enumerate
2249
2250 If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2251 warning and continue with the link.
2252 @end ifset
2253
2254 @kindex -shared
2255 @kindex -Bshareable
2256 @item -shared
2257 @itemx -Bshareable
2258 @cindex shared libraries
2259 Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2260 and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
2261 shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
2262 undefined symbols in the link.
2263
2264 @kindex --sort-common
2265 @item --sort-common
2266 @itemx --sort-common=ascending
2267 @itemx --sort-common=descending
2268 This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2269 ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2270 sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2271 eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2272 between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2273 specified, then descending order is assumed.
2274
2275 @kindex --sort-section=name
2276 @item --sort-section=name
2277 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2278 patterns in the linker script.
2279
2280 @kindex --sort-section=alignment
2281 @item --sort-section=alignment
2282 This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2283 patterns in the linker script.
2284
2285 @kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2286 @item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2287 This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2288 .dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2289 post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2290
2291 @kindex --split-by-file
2292 @item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
2293 Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
2294 each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2295 size of 1 if not given.
2296
2297 @kindex --split-by-reloc
2298 @item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
2299 Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
2300 output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
2301 This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
2302 certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2303 cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2304 that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2305 support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2306 input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2307 more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
2308 many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
2309
2310 @kindex --stats
2311 @item --stats
2312 Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2313 as execution time and memory usage.
2314
2315 @kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
2316 @item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2317 Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2318 configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2319 that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2320
2321 @kindex --task-link
2322 @item --task-link
2323 This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2324 file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2325
2326 @kindex --traditional-format
2327 @cindex traditional format
2328 @item --traditional-format
2329 For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2330 the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
2331 use the traditional format instead.
2332
2333 @cindex dbx
2334 For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
2335 symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2336 full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2337 @code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
2338 trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
2339 combine duplicate entries.
2340
2341 @kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2342 @item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2343 Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2344 address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2345 times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2346 line.
2347 @var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2348 for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2349 @samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2350 should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2351 sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2352
2353 @kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2354 @kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2355 @kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
2356 @cindex segment origins, cmd line
2357 @item -Tbss=@var{org}
2358 @itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2359 @itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2360 Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
2361 @code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
2362
2363 @kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2364 @item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2365 @cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2366 When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2367 byte of the text segment.
2368
2369 @kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2370 @item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2371 @cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2372 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2373 the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2374 text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2375
2376 @kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2377 @item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2378 @cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2379 When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2380 model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2381
2382 @kindex --unresolved-symbols
2383 @item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2384 Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2385 values for @samp{method}:
2386
2387 @table @samp
2388 @item ignore-all
2389 Do not report any unresolved symbols.
2390
2391 @item report-all
2392 Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
2393
2394 @item ignore-in-object-files
2395 Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2396 ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2397
2398 @item ignore-in-shared-libs
2399 Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2400 ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2401 when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2402 libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2403 command line.
2404 @end table
2405
2406 The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2407 by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2408
2409 Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2410 unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2411 can change this to a warning.
2412
2413 @kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2414 @cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2415 @item --dll-verbose
2416 @itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2417 Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
2418 supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
2419 the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2420 argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
2421
2422 @kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2423 @cindex version script, symbol versions
2424 @item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2425 Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2426 used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
2427 about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
2428 is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2429 see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2430 use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2431 symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2432 @xref{WIN32}.
2433
2434 @kindex --warn-common
2435 @cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2436 @cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2437 @item --warn-common
2438 Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
2439 a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
2440 but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2441 you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
2442 Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
2443 warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2444
2445 There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2446
2447 @table @samp
2448 @item int i = 1;
2449 A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2450 file.
2451
2452 @item extern int i;
2453 An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2454 There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2455 variable somewhere.
2456
2457 @item int i;
2458 A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2459 variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2460 The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2461 single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2462 size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2463 a definition of the same variable.
2464 @end table
2465
2466 The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2467 Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2468 just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2469 encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2470 a common symbol.
2471
2472 @enumerate
2473 @item
2474 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2475 definition for the symbol.
2476 @smallexample
2477 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2478 overridden by definition
2479 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2480 @end smallexample
2481
2482 @item
2483 Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2484 the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2485 except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2486 @smallexample
2487 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2488 overriding common
2489 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2490 @end smallexample
2491
2492 @item
2493 Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2494 @smallexample
2495 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2496 of `@var{symbol}'
2497 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2498 @end smallexample
2499
2500 @item
2501 Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2502 @smallexample
2503 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2504 overridden by larger common
2505 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2506 @end smallexample
2507
2508 @item
2509 Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2510 the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2511 encountered in a different order.
2512 @smallexample
2513 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2514 overriding smaller common
2515 @var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2516 @end smallexample
2517 @end enumerate
2518
2519 @kindex --warn-constructors
2520 @item --warn-constructors
2521 Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2522 object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2523 detect the use of global constructors.
2524
2525 @kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2526 @item --warn-multiple-gp
2527 Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2528 This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2529 Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2530 section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2531 of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2532 base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2533 base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2534 bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2535 large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2536 values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2537 option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2538
2539 @kindex --warn-once
2540 @cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2541 @cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2542 @item --warn-once
2543 Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2544 which refers to it.
2545
2546 @kindex --warn-section-align
2547 @cindex warnings, on section alignment
2548 @cindex section alignment, warnings on
2549 @item --warn-section-align
2550 Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2551 alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2552 The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2553 is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2554 the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2555
2556 @kindex --warn-textrel
2557 @item --warn-textrel
2558 Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2559 or shared object.
2560
2561 @kindex --warn-alternate-em
2562 @item --warn-alternate-em
2563 Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2564
2565 @kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2566 @item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2567 If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2568 @option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2569 This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2570
2571 @kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2572 @item --error-unresolved-symbols
2573 This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2574 it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2575
2576 @kindex --whole-archive
2577 @cindex including an entire archive
2578 @item --whole-archive
2579 For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
2580 @option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
2581 in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2582 files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2583 library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2584 library. This option may be used more than once.
2585
2586 Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
2587 about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2588 Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
2589 list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2590 your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2591
2592 @kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2593 @item --wrap=@var{symbol}
2594 Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2595 @var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2596 undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2597 @var{symbol}.
2598
2599 This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2600 wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2601 wishes to call the system function, it should call
2602 @code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2603
2604 Here is a trivial example:
2605
2606 @smallexample
2607 void *
2608 __wrap_malloc (size_t c)
2609 @{
2610 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
2611 return __real_malloc (c);
2612 @}
2613 @end smallexample
2614
2615 If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
2616 all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2617 instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2618 call the real @code{malloc} function.
2619
2620 You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
2621 links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
2622 you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2623 file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2624 call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2625
2626 Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2627 internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2628 @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2629 @code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2630
2631 @smallexample
2632 int
2633 f (void)
2634 @{
2635 return 123;
2636 @}
2637
2638 int
2639 g (void)
2640 @{
2641 return f();
2642 @}
2643 @end smallexample
2644
2645 @kindex --eh-frame-hdr
2646 @kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
2647 @item --eh-frame-hdr
2648 @itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2649 Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2650 (@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2651 section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
2652
2653 @kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2654 @item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2655 Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2656 generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2657 if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2658
2659 @kindex --enable-new-dtags
2660 @kindex --disable-new-dtags
2661 @item --enable-new-dtags
2662 @itemx --disable-new-dtags
2663 This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2664 systems may not understand them. If you specify
2665 @option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2666 and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
2667 If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
2668 created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2669 those options are only available for ELF systems.
2670
2671 @kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
2672 @item --hash-size=@var{number}
2673 Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2674 close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2675 time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2676 increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2677 value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2678
2679 @kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2680 @item --hash-style=@var{style}
2681 Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2682 @code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2683 new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2684 the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
2685 hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2686 but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
2687
2688 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2689 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2690 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2691 @kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2692 @item --compress-debug-sections=none
2693 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2694 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2695 @itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2696 On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2697 compressed using zlib.
2698
2699 @option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2700 sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2701 DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2702 instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2703 also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2704 sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2705
2706 The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2707 @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2708
2709 Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2710 sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2711 for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2712 uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2713
2714 The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2715 involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2716 default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2717 @option{--help} option.
2718
2719 @kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2720 @item --reduce-memory-overheads
2721 This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
2722 linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
2723 for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2724 about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2725
2726 Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2727 1021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
2728 run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2729 has been used.
2730
2731 The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2732 enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
2733
2734 @kindex --build-id
2735 @kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2736 @item --build-id
2737 @itemx --build-id=@var{style}
2738 Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
2739 or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
2740 unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2741 @code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2742 @sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2743 @code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2744 the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2745 string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2746 @code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2747 is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
2748
2749 The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2750 that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2751 unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2752 to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2753 file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2754 string identifying the original linked file does not change.
2755
2756 Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2757 @code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
2758 @end table
2759
2760 @c man end
2761
2762 @subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
2763
2764 @c man begin OPTIONS
2765
2766 The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
2767 the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2768 normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2769 use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2770 @code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2771 like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2772 symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2773 object file).
2774
2775 In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
2776 support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
2777 PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2778 values by either a space or an equals sign.
2779
2780 @table @gcctabopt
2781
2782 @kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2783 @item --add-stdcall-alias
2784 If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2785 as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
2786 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2787
2788 @kindex --base-file
2789 @item --base-file @var{file}
2790 Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2791 addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2792 @file{dlltool}.
2793 [This is an i386 PE specific option]
2794
2795 @kindex --dll
2796 @item --dll
2797 Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
2798 @option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
2799 file.
2800 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2801
2802 @kindex --enable-long-section-names
2803 @kindex --disable-long-section-names
2804 @item --enable-long-section-names
2805 @itemx --disable-long-section-names
2806 The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
2807 the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
2808 for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2809 fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
2810 to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2811 allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2812 disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2813 generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2814 as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
2815 with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2816 GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
2817 information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2818 option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2819 section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2820 when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2821 image and not stripping symbols.
2822 [This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2823
2824 @kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2825 @kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2826 @item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2827 @itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2828 If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
2829 do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
2830 only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2831 resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2832 undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2833 @code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2834 to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2835 warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2836 import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
2837 to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
2838 feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
2839 @option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
2840 mismatches are considered to be errors.
2841 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2842
2843 @kindex --leading-underscore
2844 @kindex --no-leading-underscore
2845 @item --leading-underscore
2846 @itemx --no-leading-underscore
2847 For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2848 in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2849 disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2850
2851 @cindex DLLs, creating
2852 @kindex --export-all-symbols
2853 @item --export-all-symbols
2854 If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2855 be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2856 otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2857 explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2858 attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2859 option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
2860 @code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
2861 @code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
2862 exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2863 re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2864 such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2865 @code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
2866 @code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2867 Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2868 not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
2869 extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
2870 (obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
2871 These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2872 @code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
2873 @code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
2874 @code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
2875 @code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
2876 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2877
2878 @kindex --exclude-symbols
2879 @item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
2880 Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2881 exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
2882 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2883
2884 @kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2885 @item --exclude-all-symbols
2886 Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2887 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2888
2889 @kindex --file-alignment
2890 @item --file-alignment
2891 Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2892 file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2893 512.
2894 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2895
2896 @cindex heap size
2897 @kindex --heap
2898 @item --heap @var{reserve}
2899 @itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
2900 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
2901 to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
2902 committed.
2903 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2904
2905 @cindex image base
2906 @kindex --image-base
2907 @item --image-base @var{value}
2908 Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2909 the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2910 is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2911 your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2912 other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2913 for dlls.
2914 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2915
2916 @kindex --kill-at
2917 @item --kill-at
2918 If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2919 symbols before they are exported.
2920 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2921
2922 @kindex --large-address-aware
2923 @item --large-address-aware
2924 If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
2925 header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
2926 greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
2927 or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2928 section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2929 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2930
2931 @kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2932 @item --disable-large-address-aware
2933 Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2934 This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2935 driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2936 addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2937 [This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2938
2939 @kindex --major-image-version
2940 @item --major-image-version @var{value}
2941 Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
2942 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2943
2944 @kindex --major-os-version
2945 @item --major-os-version @var{value}
2946 Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
2947 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2948
2949 @kindex --major-subsystem-version
2950 @item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
2951 Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
2952 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2953
2954 @kindex --minor-image-version
2955 @item --minor-image-version @var{value}
2956 Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
2957 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2958
2959 @kindex --minor-os-version
2960 @item --minor-os-version @var{value}
2961 Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
2962 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2963
2964 @kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2965 @item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
2966 Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
2967 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2968
2969 @cindex DEF files, creating
2970 @cindex DLLs, creating
2971 @kindex --output-def
2972 @item --output-def @var{file}
2973 The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2974 file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2975 (which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2976 library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2977 automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
2978 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2979
2980 @cindex DLLs, creating
2981 @kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2982 @item --enable-auto-image-base
2983 @itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2984 Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2985 @var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2986 By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2987 for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2988 execution are avoided.
2989 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2990
2991 @kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2992 @item --disable-auto-image-base
2993 Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2994 user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2995 default.
2996 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2997
2998 @cindex DLLs, linking to
2999 @kindex --dll-search-prefix
3000 @item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
3001 When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
3002 search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
3003 @code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
3004 between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3005 uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
3006 @code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
3007 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3008
3009 @kindex --enable-auto-import
3010 @item --enable-auto-import
3011 Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
3012 DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3013 mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3014 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3015
3016 The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3017 feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3018
3019 Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3020 of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3021 PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
3022
3023 Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3024 data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3025 placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3026 around a problem with consts that is described here:
3027 http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3028
3029 Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3030 see this message:
3031
3032 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
3033 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3034
3035 This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3036 ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
3037 allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3038 fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3039 constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
3040 multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3041 this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3042 of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3043 the warning, and exit.
3044
3045 There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3046 data type of the exported variable:
3047
3048 One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3049 of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
3050 this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
3051
3052 A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3053 that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3054 there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
3055 a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3056
3057 @example
3058 extern type extern_array[];
3059 extern_array[1] -->
3060 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3061 @end example
3062
3063 or
3064
3065 @example
3066 extern type extern_array[];
3067 extern_array[1] -->
3068 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3069 @end example
3070
3071 For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
3072 is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
3073
3074 @example
3075 extern struct s extern_struct;
3076 extern_struct.field -->
3077 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3078 @end example
3079
3080 or
3081
3082 @example
3083 extern long long extern_ll;
3084 extern_ll -->
3085 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3086 @end example
3087
3088 A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
3089 'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
3090 @code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
3091 requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
3092 building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3093 merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3094 between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
3095 constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3096
3097 Original:
3098 @example
3099 --foo.h
3100 extern int arr[];
3101 --foo.c
3102 #include "foo.h"
3103 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3104 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3105 @}
3106 @end example
3107
3108 Solution 1:
3109 @example
3110 --foo.h
3111 extern int arr[];
3112 --foo.c
3113 #include "foo.h"
3114 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3115 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3116 volatile int *parr = arr;
3117 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3118 @}
3119 @end example
3120
3121 Solution 2:
3122 @example
3123 --foo.h
3124 /* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3125 #if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3126 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3127 #define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3128 #else
3129 #define FOO_IMPORT
3130 #endif
3131 extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3132 --foo.c
3133 #include "foo.h"
3134 void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3135 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3136 @}
3137 @end example
3138
3139 A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
3140 library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3141 for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3142 functions).
3143
3144 @kindex --disable-auto-import
3145 @item --disable-auto-import
3146 Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
3147 @code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
3148 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3149
3150 @kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3151 @item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3152 If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3153 that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3154 a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
3155 environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
3156 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3157
3158 @kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3159 @item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3160 Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
3161 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3162
3163 @kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3164 @item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3165 Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
3166 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3167
3168 @kindex --section-alignment
3169 @item --section-alignment
3170 Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3171 addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
3172 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3173
3174 @cindex stack size
3175 @kindex --stack
3176 @item --stack @var{reserve}
3177 @itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
3178 Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
3179 to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
3180 committed.
3181 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3182
3183 @kindex --subsystem
3184 @item --subsystem @var{which}
3185 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3186 @itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3187 Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3188 legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
3189 @code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3190 the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3191 @var{which}.
3192 [This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3193
3194 The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3195 of the PE file header:
3196 [These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3197
3198 @kindex --high-entropy-va
3199 @item --high-entropy-va
3200 @itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
3201 Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3202 (ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3203
3204 This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3205 @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3206
3207 @kindex --dynamicbase
3208 @item --dynamicbase
3209 @itemx --disable-dynamicbase
3210 The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3211 randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3212 Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3213 can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
3214 This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
3215
3216 @kindex --forceinteg
3217 @item --forceinteg
3218 @itemx --disable-forceinteg
3219 Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3220 default.
3221
3222 @kindex --nxcompat
3223 @item --nxcompat
3224 @item --disable-nxcompat
3225 The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3226 This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3227 targets. The option is enabled by default.
3228
3229 @kindex --no-isolation
3230 @item --no-isolation
3231 @itemx --disable-no-isolation
3232 Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3233 This option is disabled by default.
3234
3235 @kindex --no-seh
3236 @item --no-seh
3237 @itemx --disable-no-seh
3238 The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3239 this image. This option is disabled by default.
3240
3241 @kindex --no-bind
3242 @item --no-bind
3243 @itemx --disable-no-bind
3244 Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
3245
3246 @kindex --wdmdriver
3247 @item --wdmdriver
3248 @itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3249 The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3250 by default.
3251
3252 @kindex --tsaware
3253 @item --tsaware
3254 @itemx --disable-tsaware
3255 The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3256 default.
3257
3258 @kindex --insert-timestamp
3259 @item --insert-timestamp
3260 @itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3261 Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3262 as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3263 other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
3264 will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
3265 same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3266 can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
3267 that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
3268 identically.
3269
3270 @kindex --enable-reloc-section
3271 @item --enable-reloc-section
3272 @itemx --disable-reloc-section
3273 Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3274 is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
3275 This option is enabled by default.
3276 @end table
3277
3278 @c man end
3279
3280 @ifset C6X
3281 @subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3282
3283 @c man begin OPTIONS
3284
3285 The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3286 libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3287 all executables use an index of 0.
3288
3289 @table @gcctabopt
3290
3291 @kindex --dsbt-size
3292 @item --dsbt-size @var{size}
3293 This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
3294 or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3295 entries.
3296
3297 @kindex --dsbt-index
3298 @item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3299 This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3300 to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3301 executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3302 @code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3303
3304 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3305 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3306 exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3307
3308 @end table
3309
3310 @c man end
3311 @end ifset
3312
3313 @ifset CSKY
3314 @subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3315
3316 @c man begin OPTIONS
3317
3318 @table @gcctabopt
3319
3320 @kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3321 @item --branch-stub
3322 This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3323 sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3324 usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3325 can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3326 the compiler or assembler.
3327
3328 @kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3329 @item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3330 This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3331 It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3332 be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3333 stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3334 sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3335 @samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3336 linker should choose suitable defaults.
3337
3338 @end table
3339
3340 @c man end
3341 @end ifset
3342
3343 @ifset M68HC11
3344 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3345
3346 @c man begin OPTIONS
3347
3348 The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3349 memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3350
3351 @table @gcctabopt
3352
3353 @kindex --no-trampoline
3354 @item --no-trampoline
3355 This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3356 is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3357 instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3358
3359 @kindex --bank-window
3360 @item --bank-window @var{name}
3361 This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3362 the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3363 The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3364 paging and addresses within the memory window.
3365
3366 @end table
3367
3368 @c man end
3369 @end ifset
3370
3371 @ifset M68K
3372 @subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3373
3374 @c man begin OPTIONS
3375
3376 The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3377 when linking for 68K targets.
3378
3379 @table @gcctabopt
3380
3381 @kindex --got
3382 @item --got=@var{type}
3383 This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3384 @var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3385 @samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3386 Info entry for @file{ld}.
3387
3388 @end table
3389
3390 @c man end
3391 @end ifset
3392
3393 @ifset MIPS
3394 @subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3395
3396 @c man begin OPTIONS
3397
3398 The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
3399 generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3400 linking for MIPS targets.
3401
3402 @table @gcctabopt
3403
3404 @kindex --insn32
3405 @item --insn32
3406 @kindex --no-insn32
3407 @itemx --no-insn32
3408 These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3409 generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3410 or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
3411 32-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3412 used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3413 possible.
3414
3415 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3416 @item --ignore-branch-isa
3417 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3418 @itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3419 These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3420 transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3421 accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3422 is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3423 instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3424 equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3425 calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3426 a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3427 an error.
3428
3429 @kindex --compact-branches
3430 @item --compact-branches
3431 @kindex --no-compact-branches
3432 @itemx --no-compact-branches
3433 These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3434 in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3435
3436 @end table
3437
3438 @c man end
3439 @end ifset
3440
3441
3442 @ifset PDP11
3443 @subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3444
3445 @c man begin OPTIONS
3446
3447 For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3448 produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3449 for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3450 targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3451 defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3452 here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3453
3454 @table @gcctabopt
3455
3456 @kindex -N
3457 @item -N
3458 @kindex --omagic
3459 @itemx --omagic
3460
3461 Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3462 indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3463 shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3464 writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3465 the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3466 programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3467 from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3468
3469 @kindex -n
3470 @item -n
3471 @kindex --nmagic
3472 @itemx --nmagic
3473
3474 Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3475 indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3476 be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3477 file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3478 byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3479 a @emph{pure executable} format.
3480
3481 @kindex -z
3482 @item -z
3483 @kindex --imagic
3484 @itemx --imagic
3485
3486 Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3487 indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3488 data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3489 instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3490 larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3491 to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3492 shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3493 option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3494 and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3495 this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3496 executable} format.
3497
3498 @kindex --no-omagic
3499 @item --no-omagic
3500
3501 Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3502
3503 @end table
3504
3505 @c man end
3506 @end ifset
3507
3508 @ifset UsesEnvVars
3509 @node Environment
3510 @section Environment Variables
3511
3512 @c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3513
3514 You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
3515 @ifclear SingleFormat
3516 @code{GNUTARGET},
3517 @end ifclear
3518 @code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
3519
3520 @ifclear SingleFormat
3521 @kindex GNUTARGET
3522 @cindex default input format
3523 @code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3524 use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3525 of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
3526 @code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
3527 of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3528 attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3529 this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3530 there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3531 object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3532 BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3533 in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
3534 @end ifclear
3535
3536 @kindex LDEMULATION
3537 @cindex default emulation
3538 @cindex emulation, default
3539 @code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3540 @samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3541 behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3542 available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3543 the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3544 variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3545 linker was configured.
3546
3547 @kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3548 @cindex demangling, default
3549 Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3550 @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3551 default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3552 a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3553 may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3554 options.
3555
3556 @c man end
3557 @end ifset
3558
3559 @node Scripts
3560 @chapter Linker Scripts
3561
3562 @cindex scripts
3563 @cindex linker scripts
3564 @cindex command files
3565 Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3566 written in the linker command language.
3567
3568 The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3569 the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3570 the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3571 more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3572 direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3573 described below.
3574
3575 The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3576 yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
3577 linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3578 to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
3579 such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3580
3581 You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3582 line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3583 default linker script.
3584
3585 You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3586 to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3587 Linker Scripts}.
3588
3589 @menu
3590 * Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3591 * Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3592 * Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3593 * Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3594 * Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3595 * SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3596 * MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3597 * PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3598 * VERSION:: VERSION Command
3599 * Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3600 * Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3601 @end menu
3602
3603 @node Basic Script Concepts
3604 @section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3605 @cindex linker script concepts
3606 We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3607 describe the linker script language.
3608
3609 The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3610 file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3611 @dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3612 The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3613 purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3614 among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3615 section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3616 in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3617
3618 Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3619 also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
3620 contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
3621 the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3622 A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3623 area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3624 loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3625 which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3626 of debugging information.
3627
3628 Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3629 first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3630 the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3631 @dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3632 section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3633 same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3634 is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3635 (this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3636 based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3637 RAM address would be the VMA.
3638
3639 You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3640 program with the @samp{-h} option.
3641
3642 Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3643 @dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3644 has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3645 information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3646 will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3647 static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3648 referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3649
3650 You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3651 program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3652 option.
3653
3654 @node Script Format
3655 @section Linker Script Format
3656 @cindex linker script format
3657 Linker scripts are text files.
3658
3659 You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3660 either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3661 symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3662 generally ignored.
3663
3664 Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3665 If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3666 otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3667 double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3668 file name.
3669
3670 You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3671 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3672 to whitespace.
3673
3674 @node Simple Example
3675 @section Simple Linker Script Example
3676 @cindex linker script example
3677 @cindex example of linker script
3678 Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3679
3680 The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3681 @samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3682 memory layout of the output file.
3683
3684 The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3685 describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3686 code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3687 @samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3688 Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3689 your input files.
3690
3691 For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
3692 0x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3693 linker script which will do that:
3694 @smallexample
3695 SECTIONS
3696 @{
3697 . = 0x10000;
3698 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3699 . = 0x8000000;
3700 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3701 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3702 @}
3703 @end smallexample
3704
3705 You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3706 followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3707 descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3708
3709 The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3710 sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3711 counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3712 other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3713 current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3714 incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3715 @samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3716
3717 The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3718 required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3719 after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3720 which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3721 wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3722 means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3723
3724 Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3725 @samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3726 @samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3727
3728 The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3729 the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3730 at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3731 output section, the value of the location counter will be
3732 @samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3733 effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
3734 immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
3735
3736 The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3737 alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3738 example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3739 sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3740 may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3741 sections.
3742
3743 That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3744
3745 @node Simple Commands
3746 @section Simple Linker Script Commands
3747 @cindex linker script simple commands
3748 In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3749
3750 @menu
3751 * Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3752 * File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3753 @ifclear SingleFormat
3754 * Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3755 @end ifclear
3756
3757 * REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
3758 * Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3759 @end menu
3760
3761 @node Entry Point
3762 @subsection Setting the Entry Point
3763 @kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3764 @cindex start of execution
3765 @cindex first instruction
3766 @cindex entry point
3767 The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3768 point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3769 entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3770 @smallexample
3771 ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3772 @end smallexample
3773
3774 There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3775 entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3776 stopping when one of them succeeds:
3777 @itemize @bullet
3778 @item
3779 the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
3780 @item
3781 the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
3782 @item
3783 the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
3784 targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3785 check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
3786 @item
3787 the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
3788 @item
3789 The address @code{0}.
3790 @end itemize
3791
3792 @node File Commands
3793 @subsection Commands Dealing with Files
3794 @cindex linker script file commands
3795 Several linker script commands deal with files.
3796
3797 @table @code
3798 @item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3799 @kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3800 @cindex including a linker script
3801 Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3802 be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
3803 with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
3804 10 levels deep.
3805
3806 You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3807 @code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3808
3809 @item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3810 @itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3811 @kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3812 @cindex input files in linker scripts
3813 @cindex input object files in linker scripts
3814 @cindex linker script input object files
3815 The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3816 in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3817
3818 For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3819 a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3820 then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3821
3822 In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3823 script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3824
3825 In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3826 with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3827 located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
3828 for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3829 @code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3830 filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3831 @samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3832
3833 If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3834 the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3835 found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3836 not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3837 path.
3838
3839 If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
3840 name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
3841 @samp{-l}.
3842
3843 When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3844 files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3845 script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3846
3847 @item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3848 @itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3849 @kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3850 @cindex grouping input files
3851 The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3852 files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3853 new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
3854 in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3855
3856 @item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3857 @itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3858 @kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3859 This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3860 commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3861 as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3862 with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3863 when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3864 @option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3865 and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3866 setting afterwards.
3867
3868 @item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3869 @kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3870 @cindex output file name in linker script
3871 The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3872 @code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3873 @samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
3874 Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
3875 precedence.
3876
3877 You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3878 output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3879
3880 @item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3881 @kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3882 @cindex library search path in linker script
3883 @cindex archive search path in linker script
3884 @cindex search path in linker script
3885 The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
3886 @command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
3887 @code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
3888 on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
3889 are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
3890 the command-line option are searched first.
3891
3892 @item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3893 @kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3894 @cindex first input file
3895 The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3896 that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3897 though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3898 when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3899 first file.
3900 @end table
3901
3902 @ifclear SingleFormat
3903 @node Format Commands
3904 @subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
3905 A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3906
3907 @table @code
3908 @item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3909 @itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3910 @kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3911 @cindex output file format in linker script
3912 The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3913 output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
3914 exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
3915 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
3916 line option takes precedence.
3917
3918 You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
3919 formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
3920 This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3921 desired endianness.
3922
3923 If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3924 will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3925 output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3926 used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3927
3928 For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3929 command:
3930 @smallexample
3931 OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3932 @end smallexample
3933 This says that the default format for the output file is
3934 @samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
3935 option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3936 format.
3937
3938 @item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3939 @kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3940 @cindex input file format in linker script
3941 The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3942 files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3943 This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
3944 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
3945 is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3946 command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3947 @end table
3948 @end ifclear
3949
3950 @node REGION_ALIAS
3951 @subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3952 @kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3953 @cindex region alias
3954 @cindex region names
3955
3956 Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3957 @ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3958
3959 @smallexample
3960 REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3961 @end smallexample
3962
3963 The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3964 memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3965 to memory regions. An example follows.
3966
3967 Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3968 memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3969 that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3970 non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3971 access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3972 read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3973 sections:
3974
3975 @itemize @bullet
3976 @item
3977 @code{.text} program code;
3978 @item
3979 @code{.rodata} read-only data;
3980 @item
3981 @code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3982 @item
3983 @code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3984 @end itemize
3985
3986 The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3987 part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3988 output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3989 systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3990 @code{C}:
3991 @multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3992 @item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
3993 @item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
3994 @item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3995 @item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3996 @item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3997 @end multitable
3998 The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3999 loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4000 the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4001 the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4002
4003 The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4004 includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4005 memory layout:
4006 @smallexample
4007 INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4008
4009 SECTIONS
4010 @{
4011 .text :
4012 @{
4013 *(.text)
4014 @} > REGION_TEXT
4015 .rodata :
4016 @{
4017 *(.rodata)
4018 rodata_end = .;
4019 @} > REGION_RODATA
4020 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4021 @{
4022 data_start = .;
4023 *(.data)
4024 @} > REGION_DATA
4025 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4026 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4027 .bss :
4028 @{
4029 *(.bss)
4030 @} > REGION_BSS
4031 @}
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4035 regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4036 variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4037 @table @code
4038 @item A
4039 Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4040 @smallexample
4041 MEMORY
4042 @{
4043 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4044 @}
4045
4046 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4047 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4048 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4049 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4050 @end smallexample
4051 @item B
4052 Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4053 into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4054 @code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4055 @smallexample
4056 MEMORY
4057 @{
4058 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4059 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4060 @}
4061
4062 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4063 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4064 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4065 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4066 @end smallexample
4067 @item C
4068 Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4069 @code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4070 initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4071 system start into the @code{RAM}.
4072 @smallexample
4073 MEMORY
4074 @{
4075 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4076 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4077 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4078 @}
4079
4080 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4081 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4082 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4083 REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4084 @end smallexample
4085 @end table
4086
4087 It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4088 @code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4089 necessary:
4090 @smallexample
4091 #include <string.h>
4092
4093 extern char data_start [];
4094 extern char data_size [];
4095 extern char data_load_start [];
4096
4097 void copy_data(void)
4098 @{
4099 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4100 @{
4101 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4102 @}
4103 @}
4104 @end smallexample
4105
4106 @node Miscellaneous Commands
4107 @subsection Other Linker Script Commands
4108 There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4109
4110 @table @code
4111 @item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4112 @kindex ASSERT
4113 @cindex assertion in linker script
4114 Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4115 with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4116
4117 Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4118 take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4119 inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4120 for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4121 symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4122
4123 @smallexample
4124 .stack :
4125 @{
4126 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4127 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4128 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4129 @}
4130 @end smallexample
4131
4132 will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4133 PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4134 can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4135
4136 @smallexample
4137 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4138 .stack :
4139 @{
4140 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4141 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4142 @}
4143 @end smallexample
4144
4145 will work.
4146
4147 @item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4148 @kindex EXTERN
4149 @cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4150 Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4151 symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4152 modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4153 each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4154 command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4155
4156 @item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4157 @kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4158 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4159 This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
4160 to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
4161 output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4162
4163 @item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4164 @kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4165 @cindex common allocation in linker script
4166 This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4167 command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4168 to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4169
4170 @item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4171 @kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4172 @cindex group allocation in linker script
4173 @cindex section groups
4174 @cindex COMDAT
4175 This command has the same effect as the
4176 @samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4177 @command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4178 and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4179 specified (@samp{-r}).
4180
4181 @item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4182 @kindex INSERT
4183 @cindex insert user script into default script
4184 This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4185 augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4186 inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4187 @var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4188 default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4189 sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4190 linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4191 insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4192 linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4193 default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4194 of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4195 to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4196 is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4197
4198 @smallexample
4199 SECTIONS
4200 @{
4201 OVERLAY :
4202 @{
4203 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4204 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4205 @}
4206 @}
4207 INSERT AFTER .text;
4208 @end smallexample
4209
4210 @item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4211 @kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4212 @cindex cross references
4213 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4214 references among certain output sections.
4215
4216 In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4217 using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4218 will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4219 errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4220 a function defined in the other section.
4221
4222 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
4223 @command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
4224 an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4225 @code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4226 names.
4227
4228 @item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4229 @kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4230 @cindex cross references
4231 This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4232 references to one section from a list of other sections.
4233
4234 The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4235 output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4236 a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4237 there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4238 must never call back.
4239
4240 The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4241 The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4242 If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4243 the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4244 status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4245 names, not input section names.
4246
4247 @ifclear SingleFormat
4248 @item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4249 @kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4250 @cindex machine architecture
4251 @cindex architecture
4252 Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4253 of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4254 architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4255 the @samp{-f} option.
4256 @end ifclear
4257
4258 @item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4259 @kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4260 This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4261 @var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4262 in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4263 @xref{Expression Section}.
4264 @end table
4265
4266 @node Assignments
4267 @section Assigning Values to Symbols
4268 @cindex assignment in scripts
4269 @cindex symbol definition, scripts
4270 @cindex variables, defining
4271 You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
4272 the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
4273
4274 @menu
4275 * Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
4276 * HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
4277 * PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
4278 * PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4279 * Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
4280 @end menu
4281
4282 @node Simple Assignments
4283 @subsection Simple Assignments
4284
4285 You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4286
4287 @table @code
4288 @item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4289 @itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4290 @itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4291 @itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4292 @itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4293 @itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4294 @itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4295 @itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4296 @itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4297 @end table
4298
4299 The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4300 @var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4301 defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4302
4303 The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
4304 may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
4305
4306 The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4307
4308 Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4309
4310 You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4311 statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4312 section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4313
4314 The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4315 expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4316
4317 Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4318 assignments may be used:
4319
4320 @smallexample
4321 floating_point = 0;
4322 SECTIONS
4323 @{
4324 .text :
4325 @{
4326 *(.text)
4327 _etext = .;
4328 @}
4329 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
4330 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4331 @}
4332 @end smallexample
4333 @noindent
4334 In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4335 zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4336 the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4337 defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4338 upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4339
4340 @node HIDDEN
4341 @subsection HIDDEN
4342 @cindex HIDDEN
4343 For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4344 exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4345
4346 Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4347 @code{HIDDEN}:
4348
4349 @smallexample
4350 HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4351 SECTIONS
4352 @{
4353 .text :
4354 @{
4355 *(.text)
4356 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4357 @}
4358 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4359 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4360 @}
4361 @end smallexample
4362 @noindent
4363 In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4364
4365 @node PROVIDE
4366 @subsection PROVIDE
4367 @cindex PROVIDE
4368 In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4369 only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4370 the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4371 @samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4372 @samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4373 @code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4374 @samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4375 @code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4376
4377 Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4378 @smallexample
4379 SECTIONS
4380 @{
4381 .text :
4382 @{
4383 *(.text)
4384 _etext = .;
4385 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4386 @}
4387 @}
4388 @end smallexample
4389
4390 In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4391 underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4392 the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4393 underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4394 If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4395 linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4396
4397 Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4398 defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4399 that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4400 when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4401 @samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4402
4403 @node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4404 @subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4405 @cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4406 Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4407 hidden and won't be exported.
4408
4409 @node Source Code Reference
4410 @subsection Source Code Reference
4411
4412 Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4413 intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4414 a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4415 symbol that does not have a value.
4416
4417 Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4418 transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4419 stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4420 prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4421 mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4422 of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4423 variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4424 linker script variable might be referred to as:
4425
4426 @smallexample
4427 extern int foo;
4428 @end smallexample
4429
4430 But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4431
4432 @smallexample
4433 _foo = 1000;
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4437 transformation has taken place.
4438
4439 When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4440 things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4441 in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4442 second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4443 table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4444 contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4445 value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4446
4447 @smallexample
4448 int foo = 1000;
4449 @end smallexample
4450
4451 creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
4452 holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4453 number 1000 is initially stored.
4454
4455 When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4456 first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4457 memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4458 So:
4459
4460 @smallexample
4461 foo = 1;
4462 @end smallexample
4463
4464 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4465 associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4466 address. Whereas:
4467
4468 @smallexample
4469 int * a = & foo;
4470 @end smallexample
4471
4472 looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
4473 and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4474 the variable @samp{a}.
4475
4476 Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4477 the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4478 an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4479
4480 @smallexample
4481 foo = 1000;
4482 @end smallexample
4483
4484 creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4485 the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4486 address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4487 linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4488 access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4489
4490 Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4491 you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4492 use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4493 section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4494 linker script contains these declarations:
4495
4496 @smallexample
4497 @group
4498 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
4499 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
4500 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4501 @end group
4502 @end smallexample
4503
4504 Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 @group
4508 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
4509
4510 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4511 @end group
4512 @end smallexample
4513
4514 Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
4515 Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4516 arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4517
4518 @smallexample
4519 @group
4520 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4521
4522 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4523 @end group
4524 @end smallexample
4525
4526 Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4527 operators.
4528
4529 @node SECTIONS
4530 @section SECTIONS Command
4531 @kindex SECTIONS
4532 The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4533 into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4534
4535 The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4536 @smallexample
4537 SECTIONS
4538 @{
4539 @var{sections-command}
4540 @var{sections-command}
4541 @dots{}
4542 @}
4543 @end smallexample
4544
4545 Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4546
4547 @itemize @bullet
4548 @item
4549 an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4550 @item
4551 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4552 @item
4553 an output section description
4554 @item
4555 an overlay description
4556 @end itemize
4557
4558 The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4559 @code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4560 those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4561 understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4562 the layout of the output file.
4563
4564 Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4565 below.
4566
4567 If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4568 linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4569 section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4570 input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4571 example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4572 in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4573
4574 @menu
4575 * Output Section Description:: Output section description
4576 * Output Section Name:: Output section name
4577 * Output Section Address:: Output section address
4578 * Input Section:: Input section description
4579 * Output Section Data:: Output section data
4580 * Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4581 * Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4582 * Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4583 * Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4584 @end menu
4585
4586 @node Output Section Description
4587 @subsection Output Section Description
4588 The full description of an output section looks like this:
4589 @smallexample
4590 @group
4591 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
4592 [AT(@var{lma})]
4593 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
4594 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4595 [@var{constraint}]
4596 @{
4597 @var{output-section-command}
4598 @var{output-section-command}
4599 @dots{}
4600 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
4601 @end group
4602 @end smallexample
4603
4604 Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4605
4606 The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4607 name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
4608 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4609 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
4610 The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4611
4612 Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4613
4614 @itemize @bullet
4615 @item
4616 a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4617 @item
4618 an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4619 @item
4620 data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4621 @item
4622 a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4623 @end itemize
4624
4625 @node Output Section Name
4626 @subsection Output Section Name
4627 @cindex name, section
4628 @cindex section name
4629 The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4630 meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4631 support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4632 must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4633 example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4634 output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4635 names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4636 quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4637 characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4638 commas must be quoted.
4639
4640 The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4641 Discarding}.
4642
4643 @node Output Section Address
4644 @subsection Output Section Address
4645 @cindex address, section
4646 @cindex section address
4647 The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
4648 address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4649 is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4650
4651 If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4652 section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4653 to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4654 alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4655 contained within the output section.
4656
4657 The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4658
4659 @itemize @bullet
4660 @item
4661 If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4662 is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4663 in that region.
4664
4665 @item
4666 If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4667 regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4668 section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4669 be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4670
4671 @item
4672 If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4673 the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4674 counter.
4675 @end itemize
4676
4677 @noindent
4678 For example:
4679
4680 @smallexample
4681 .text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4682 @end smallexample
4683
4684 @noindent
4685 and
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4689 @end smallexample
4690
4691 @noindent
4692 are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4693 @samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4694 counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
4695 counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4696 input sections.
4697
4698 The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4699 For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4700 so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4701 do something like this:
4702 @smallexample
4703 .text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4704 @end smallexample
4705 @noindent
4706 This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4707 aligned upward to the specified value.
4708
4709 Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
4710 location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4711 sections are ignored).
4712
4713 @node Input Section
4714 @subsection Input Section Description
4715 @cindex input sections
4716 @cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4717 The most common output section command is an input section description.
4718
4719 The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4720 You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4721 in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4722 map the input files into your memory layout.
4723
4724 @menu
4725 * Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4726 * Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4727 * Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4728 * Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4729 * Input Section Example:: Input section example
4730 @end menu
4731
4732 @node Input Section Basics
4733 @subsubsection Input Section Basics
4734 @cindex input section basics
4735 An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4736 by a list of section names in parentheses.
4737
4738 The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4739 describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4740
4741 The most common input section description is to include all input
4742 sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4743 include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4744 @smallexample
4745 *(.text)
4746 @end smallexample
4747 @noindent
4748 Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
4749 @cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
4750 of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4751 match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4752 example:
4753 @smallexample
4754 EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4755 @end smallexample
4756 @noindent
4757 will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4758 and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4759 placed inside the section list, for example:
4760 @smallexample
4761 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
4762 @end smallexample
4763 @noindent
4764 The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4765 two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4766 more than one section, as described below.
4767
4768 There are two ways to include more than one section:
4769 @smallexample
4770 *(.text .rdata)
4771 *(.text) *(.rdata)
4772 @end smallexample
4773 @noindent
4774 The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4775 @samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
4776 first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4777 they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
4778 @samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4779 @samp{.rdata} input sections.
4780
4781 When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4782 is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4783 immediately following section, for example:
4784 @smallexample
4785 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4786 @end smallexample
4787 @noindent
4788 will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4789 @file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4790 from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4791 exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
4792 could be modified to:
4793 @smallexample
4794 *(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4795 @end smallexample
4796 @noindent
4797 Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4798 before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4799 all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4800 @smallexample
4801 EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4802 @end smallexample
4803
4804 You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4805 You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4806 needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4807 @smallexample
4808 data.o(.data)
4809 @end smallexample
4810
4811 To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4812 of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4813
4814 Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4815
4816 @smallexample
4817 @group
4818 SECTIONS @{
4819 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4820 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4821 @}
4822 @end group
4823 @end smallexample
4824
4825 In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4826 input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4827 @code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4828 @samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4829 whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4830
4831 You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4832 matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4833 with no whitespace around the colon.
4834
4835 @table @samp
4836 @item archive:file
4837 matches file within archive
4838 @item archive:
4839 matches the whole archive
4840 @item :file
4841 matches file but not one in an archive
4842 @end table
4843
4844 Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4845 wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4846 single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4847 @samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4848 within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4849 also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4850 other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4851 from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4852 command.
4853
4854 If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4855 the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4856 commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4857 @smallexample
4858 data.o
4859 @end smallexample
4860
4861 When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4862 and does not contain any wild card
4863 characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4864 name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4865 did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4866 though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4867 @code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4868 the archive search path.
4869
4870 @node Input Section Wildcards
4871 @subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
4872 @cindex input section wildcards
4873 @cindex wildcard file name patterns
4874 @cindex file name wildcard patterns
4875 @cindex section name wildcard patterns
4876 In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4877 name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4878
4879 The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4880 pattern for the file name.
4881
4882 The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4883
4884 @table @samp
4885 @item *
4886 matches any number of characters
4887 @item ?
4888 matches any single character
4889 @item [@var{chars}]
4890 matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4891 character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4892 @samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4893 @item \
4894 quotes the following character
4895 @end table
4896
4897 When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4898 will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4899 Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4900 exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4901 @samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4902 a @samp{/} character.
4903
4904 File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4905 specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4906 does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4907
4908 If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4909 appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4910 will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4911 sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4912 @file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4913 @smallexample
4914 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4915 .data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4916 @end smallexample
4917
4918 @cindex SORT_BY_NAME
4919 Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4920 in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
4921 this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4922 pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4923 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
4924 into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4925
4926 @cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
4927 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4928 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4929 alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4930 alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4931 needed.
4932
4933 @cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
4934 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4935 @code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4936 numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4937 section name before placing them in the output file. In
4938 @code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4939 the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4940 @code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
4941
4942 @cindex SORT
4943 @code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4944
4945 When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4946 can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4947
4948 @enumerate
4949 @item
4950 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4951 It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
4952 sections have the same name.
4953 @item
4954 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4955 It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
4956 sections have the same alignment.
4957 @item
4958 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
4959 treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4960 @item
4961 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4962 is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4963 @item
4964 All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4965 @end enumerate
4966
4967 When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
4968 section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
4969 takes precedence over the command-line option.
4970
4971 If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
4972 command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
4973 treated as nested sorting command.
4974
4975 @enumerate
4976 @item
4977 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4978 @option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4979 @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4980 @item
4981 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4982 @option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4983 @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4984 @end enumerate
4985
4986 If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
4987 command-line option will be ignored.
4988
4989 @cindex SORT_NONE
4990 @code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
4991 section sorting option.
4992
4993 If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4994 @samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4995 precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4996
4997 This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4998 files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4999 sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5000 The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5001 with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5002 linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5003 @smallexample
5004 @group
5005 SECTIONS @{
5006 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5007 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5008 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5009 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5010 @}
5011 @end group
5012 @end smallexample
5013
5014 @node Input Section Common
5015 @subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
5016 @cindex common symbol placement
5017 @cindex uninitialized data placement
5018 A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5019 file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5020 linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5021 named @samp{COMMON}.
5022
5023 You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5024 other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5025 particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5026 input files are placed in another section.
5027
5028 In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5029 @samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5030 @smallexample
5031 .bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5032 @end smallexample
5033
5034 @cindex scommon section
5035 @cindex small common symbols
5036 Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5037 example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5038 symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5039 different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5040 the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5041 symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5042 to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5043 locations.
5044
5045 @cindex [COMMON]
5046 You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5047 notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5048 @samp{*(COMMON)}.
5049
5050 @node Input Section Keep
5051 @subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
5052 @cindex KEEP
5053 @cindex garbage collection
5054 When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
5055 it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
5056 This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5057 with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
5058 @code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
5059
5060 @node Input Section Example
5061 @subsubsection Input Section Example
5062 The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5063 to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5064 start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5065 @samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5066 follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5067 @samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5068 @samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5069 All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5070 files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5071
5072 @smallexample
5073 @group
5074 SECTIONS @{
5075 outputa 0x10000 :
5076 @{
5077 all.o
5078 foo.o (.input1)
5079 @}
5080 @end group
5081 @group
5082 outputb :
5083 @{
5084 foo.o (.input2)
5085 foo1.o (.input1)
5086 @}
5087 @end group
5088 @group
5089 outputc :
5090 @{
5091 *(.input1)
5092 *(.input2)
5093 @}
5094 @}
5095 @end group
5096 @end smallexample
5097
5098 If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5099 and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5100 automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5101 __stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5102 indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5103 respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5104 C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5105
5106 @node Output Section Data
5107 @subsection Output Section Data
5108 @cindex data
5109 @cindex section data
5110 @cindex output section data
5111 @kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5112 @kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5113 @kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5114 @kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5115 @kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5116 You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5117 @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5118 an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5119 parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5120 value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5121 counter.
5122
5123 The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5124 store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5125 bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5126 stored.
5127
5128 For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5129 of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5130 @smallexample
5131 BYTE(1)
5132 LONG(addr)
5133 @end smallexample
5134
5135 When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5136 same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5137 target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5138 @code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5139 @code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5140
5141 If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5142 which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5143 When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5144 true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5145 endianness of the first input object file.
5146
5147 Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
5148 between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5149 @smallexample
5150 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5151 @end smallexample
5152 whereas this will work:
5153 @smallexample
5154 SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5155 @end smallexample
5156
5157 @kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5158 @cindex holes, filling
5159 @cindex unspecified memory
5160 You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5161 current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5162 otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5163 gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
5164 with the value of the expression, repeated as
5165 necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5166 point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5167 than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5168 different parts of an output section.
5169
5170 This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
5171 value @samp{0x90}:
5172 @smallexample
5173 FILL(0x90909090)
5174 @end smallexample
5175
5176 The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
5177 section attribute, but it only affects the
5178 part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5179 entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
5180 precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
5181 expression.
5182
5183 @node Output Section Keywords
5184 @subsection Output Section Keywords
5185 There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5186 commands.
5187
5188 @table @code
5189 @kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5190 @cindex input filename symbols
5191 @cindex filename symbols
5192 @item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5193 The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5194 The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5195 file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5196 the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5197
5198 This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5199 normally used for any other object file format.
5200
5201 @kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5202 @cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5203 @cindex constructors, arranging in link
5204 @item CONSTRUCTORS
5205 When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5206 unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5207 destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5208 arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5209 automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5210 For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5211 linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5212 @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5213 ignored for other object file formats.
5214
5215 The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
5216 constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5217 Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5218 the start and end of the global destructors. The
5219 first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5220 of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5221 compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5222 formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5223 @code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5224 the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5225 destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5226 @code{exit}.
5227
5228 For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5229 arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5230 addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5231 and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5232 linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5233 runtime code expects to see.
5234
5235 @smallexample
5236 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5237 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5238 *(.ctors)
5239 LONG(0)
5240 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5241 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5242 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5243 *(.dtors)
5244 LONG(0)
5245 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5246 @end smallexample
5247
5248 If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5249 which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5250 are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5251 are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
5252 command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5253 @code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5254 @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
5255 @samp{*(.dtors)}.
5256
5257 Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5258 and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5259 need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5260 scripts.
5261
5262 @end table
5263
5264 @node Output Section Discarding
5265 @subsection Output Section Discarding
5266 @cindex discarding sections
5267 @cindex sections, discarding
5268 @cindex removing sections
5269 The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5270 This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5271 may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
5272 @smallexample
5273 .foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
5274 @end smallexample
5275 @noindent
5276 will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
5277 @samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5278 sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
5279 space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5280 too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5281 space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5282 @samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5283 @samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5284 This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
5285
5286 The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
5287 on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5288 symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
5289 the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5290 section is discarded.
5291
5292 @cindex /DISCARD/
5293 The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5294 input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5295 section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5296
5297 This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5298 @code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5299 garbage collection.
5300
5301 Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5302 discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5303 members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5304 Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5305
5306 @node Output Section Attributes
5307 @subsection Output Section Attributes
5308 @cindex output section attributes
5309 We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5310 like this:
5311
5312 @smallexample
5313 @group
5314 @var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
5315 [AT(@var{lma})]
5316 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
5317 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5318 [@var{constraint}]
5319 @{
5320 @var{output-section-command}
5321 @var{output-section-command}
5322 @dots{}
5323 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
5324 @end group
5325 @end smallexample
5326
5327 We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5328 @var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5329 remaining section attributes.
5330
5331 @menu
5332 * Output Section Type:: Output section type
5333 * Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
5334 * Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
5335 * Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
5336 * Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
5337 * Output Section Region:: Output section region
5338 * Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5339 * Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5340 @end menu
5341
5342 @node Output Section Type
5343 @subsubsection Output Section Type
5344 Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5345 parentheses. The following types are defined:
5346
5347 @table @code
5348 @item NOLOAD
5349 The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5350 loaded into memory when the program is run.
5351 @item DSECT
5352 @itemx COPY
5353 @itemx INFO
5354 @itemx OVERLAY
5355 These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5356 rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5357 marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5358 section when the program is run.
5359 @end table
5360
5361 @kindex NOLOAD
5362 @cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5363 @cindex loading, preventing
5364 The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5365 the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5366 the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5367 @samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
5368 need to be loaded when the program is run.
5369 @smallexample
5370 @group
5371 SECTIONS @{
5372 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5373 @dots{}
5374 @}
5375 @end group
5376 @end smallexample
5377
5378 @node Output Section LMA
5379 @subsubsection Output Section LMA
5380 @kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
5381 @kindex AT(@var{lma})
5382 @cindex load address
5383 @cindex section load address
5384 Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
5385 @ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5386 @pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5387 specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5388 address is optional.
5389
5390 The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5391 specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5392 takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5393 load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5394 region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
5395
5396 If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
5397 section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5398 load address:
5399
5400 @itemize @bullet
5401 @item
5402 If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5403 the LMA address as well.
5404
5405 @item
5406 If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5407
5408 @item
5409 Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5410 with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5411 section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5412 VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5413 the last section in the located region.
5414
5415 @item
5416 If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5417 that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5418
5419 @item
5420 If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5421 section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5422 @end itemize
5423
5424 @cindex ROM initialized data
5425 @cindex initialized data in ROM
5426 This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5427 example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5428 called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5429 @samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5430 even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5431 uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5432 defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5433 counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 @group
5437 SECTIONS
5438 @{
5439 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
5440 .mdata 0x2000 :
5441 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5442 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5443 .bss 0x3000 :
5444 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5445 @}
5446 @end group
5447 @end smallexample
5448
5449 The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5450 this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5451 the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5452 how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5453 script.
5454
5455 @smallexample
5456 @group
5457 extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5458 char *src = &_etext;
5459 char *dst = &_data;
5460
5461 /* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5462 while (dst < &_edata)
5463 *dst++ = *src++;
5464
5465 /* Zero bss. */
5466 for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5467 *dst = 0;
5468 @end group
5469 @end smallexample
5470
5471 @node Forced Output Alignment
5472 @subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5473 @kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5474 @cindex forcing output section alignment
5475 @cindex output section alignment
5476 You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
5477 alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5478 intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
5479
5480 @node Forced Input Alignment
5481 @subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5482 @kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5483 @cindex forcing input section alignment
5484 @cindex input section alignment
5485 You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5486 SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5487 sections, whether larger or smaller.
5488
5489 @node Output Section Constraint
5490 @subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5491 @kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5492 @kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5493 @cindex constraints on output sections
5494 You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5495 of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5496 read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5497 @code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5498
5499 @node Output Section Region
5500 @subsubsection Output Section Region
5501 @kindex >@var{region}
5502 @cindex section, assigning to memory region
5503 @cindex memory regions and sections
5504 You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5505 using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5506
5507 Here is a simple example:
5508 @smallexample
5509 @group
5510 MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5511 SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5512 @end group
5513 @end smallexample
5514
5515 @node Output Section Phdr
5516 @subsubsection Output Section Phdr
5517 @kindex :@var{phdr}
5518 @cindex section, assigning to program header
5519 @cindex program headers and sections
5520 You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5521 using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5522 one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5523 assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5524 @code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5525 linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5526
5527 Here is a simple example:
5528 @smallexample
5529 @group
5530 PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5531 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5532 @end group
5533 @end smallexample
5534
5535 @node Output Section Fill
5536 @subsubsection Output Section Fill
5537 @kindex =@var{fillexp}
5538 @cindex section fill pattern
5539 @cindex fill pattern, entire section
5540 You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5541 @samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5542 (@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5543 within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
5544 alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5545 necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
5546 of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
5547 an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5548 fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
5549 other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
5550 pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5551 expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
5552
5553 You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
5554 output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
5555
5556 Here is a simple example:
5557 @smallexample
5558 @group
5559 SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
5560 @end group
5561 @end smallexample
5562
5563 @node Overlay Description
5564 @subsection Overlay Description
5565 @kindex OVERLAY
5566 @cindex overlays
5567 An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5568 are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5569 the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5570 copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5571 required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5572 can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5573 than another.
5574
5575 Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5576 @code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5577 output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5578 command is as follows:
5579 @smallexample
5580 @group
5581 OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5582 @{
5583 @var{secname1}
5584 @{
5585 @var{output-section-command}
5586 @var{output-section-command}
5587 @dots{}
5588 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5589 @var{secname2}
5590 @{
5591 @var{output-section-command}
5592 @var{output-section-command}
5593 @dots{}
5594 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5595 @dots{}
5596 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
5597 @end group
5598 @end smallexample
5599
5600 Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5601 section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5602 section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
5603 those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
5604 except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5605 sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5606
5607 The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5608 the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5609
5610 The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5611 addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5612 memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5613 whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5614 and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5615 and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5616
5617 If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5618 references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5619 the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5620 sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5621 @xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
5622
5623 For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
5624 provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
5625 defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5626 @code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5627 the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5628 within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5629 symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5630
5631 At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5632 the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5633
5634 Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5635 @code{SECTIONS} construct.
5636 @smallexample
5637 @group
5638 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5639 @{
5640 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5641 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5642 @}
5643 @end group
5644 @end smallexample
5645 @noindent
5646 This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5647 address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5648 @samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
5649 following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
5650 @code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5651 @code{__load_stop_text1}.
5652
5653 C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5654 like the following.
5655
5656 @smallexample
5657 @group
5658 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5659 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5660 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5661 @end group
5662 @end smallexample
5663
5664 Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5665 everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5666 example could have been written identically as follows.
5667
5668 @smallexample
5669 @group
5670 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5671 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5672 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
5673 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5674 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5675 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
5676 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5677 @end group
5678 @end smallexample
5679
5680 @node MEMORY
5681 @section MEMORY Command
5682 @kindex MEMORY
5683 @cindex memory regions
5684 @cindex regions of memory
5685 @cindex allocating memory
5686 @cindex discontinuous memory
5687 The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5688 memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5689
5690 The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5691 memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5692 may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5693 can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5694 set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5695 regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5696 around to fit into the available regions.
5697
5698 A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5699 however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5700 specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5701 @code{MEMORY} is:
5702 @smallexample
5703 @group
5704 MEMORY
5705 @{
5706 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5707 @dots{}
5708 @}
5709 @end group
5710 @end smallexample
5711
5712 The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5713 region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5714 Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5715 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
5716 must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5717 add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
5718 command.
5719
5720 @cindex memory region attributes
5721 The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5722 whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5723 not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5724 @ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5725 section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5726 the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5727 them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5728
5729 The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5730 @table @samp
5731 @item R
5732 Read-only section
5733 @item W
5734 Read/write section
5735 @item X
5736 Executable section
5737 @item A
5738 Allocatable section
5739 @item I
5740 Initialized section
5741 @item L
5742 Same as @samp{I}
5743 @item !
5744 Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
5745 @end table
5746
5747 If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
5748 @samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
5749 attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5750 unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5751 not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5752 string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5753 or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5754 the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
5755
5756 @kindex ORIGIN =
5757 @kindex o =
5758 @kindex org =
5759 The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5760 the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5761 cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5762 abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5763 @code{ORG}).
5764
5765 @kindex LENGTH =
5766 @kindex len =
5767 @kindex l =
5768 The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5769 region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
5770 be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5771 @code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
5772
5773 In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5774 available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5775 and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5776 linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5777 is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5778 or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5779 explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5780 region.
5781
5782 @smallexample
5783 @group
5784 MEMORY
5785 @{
5786 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5787 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5788 @}
5789 @end group
5790 @end smallexample
5791
5792 Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5793 specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5794 @samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5795 a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5796 output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5797 was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5798 the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5799 output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5800 region, the linker will issue an error message.
5801
5802 It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
5803 expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
5804 @code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5805
5806 @smallexample
5807 @group
5808 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
5809 @end group
5810 @end smallexample
5811
5812 @node PHDRS
5813 @section PHDRS Command
5814 @kindex PHDRS
5815 @cindex program headers
5816 @cindex ELF program headers
5817 @cindex program segments
5818 @cindex segments, ELF
5819 The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5820 @dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5821 loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5822 program with the @samp{-p} option.
5823
5824 When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5825 reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5826 program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5827 This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5828 interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5829
5830 The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5831 in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5832 precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5833 the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5834 not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5835
5836 The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5837 generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5838 ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5839
5840 This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5841 @code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5842
5843 @smallexample
5844 @group
5845 PHDRS
5846 @{
5847 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5848 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5849 @}
5850 @end group
5851 @end smallexample
5852
5853 The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5854 of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5855 header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5856 with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5857 must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5858 is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
5859
5860 Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5861 system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5862 specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5863 sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5864 attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5865 Section Phdr}.
5866
5867 It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5868 merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5869 repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5870 contain the section.
5871
5872 If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5873 then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5874 not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5875 convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5876 placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5877 default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5878 segment at all.
5879
5880 @kindex FILEHDR
5881 @kindex PHDRS
5882 You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
5883 the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5884 The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5885 file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5886 include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
5887 segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5888 these keywords.
5889
5890 The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5891 value of the keyword.
5892
5893 @table @asis
5894 @item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5895 Indicates an unused program header.
5896
5897 @item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5898 Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5899 the file.
5900
5901 @item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5902 Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5903
5904 @item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5905 Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5906 found.
5907
5908 @item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5909 Indicates a segment holding note information.
5910
5911 @item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5912 A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5913 ABI.
5914
5915 @item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5916 Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5917
5918 @item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5919 Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5920
5921 @item @var{expression}
5922 An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5923 be used for types not defined above.
5924 @end table
5925
5926 You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5927 in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5928 @code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5929 Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5930 output section attribute.
5931
5932 The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5933 which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5934 explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5935 an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5936 header.
5937
5938 Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5939 headers used on a native ELF system.
5940
5941 @example
5942 @group
5943 PHDRS
5944 @{
5945 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5946 interp PT_INTERP ;
5947 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5948 data PT_LOAD ;
5949 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5950 @}
5951
5952 SECTIONS
5953 @{
5954 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5955 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5956 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5957 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5958 @dots{}
5959 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5960 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5961 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5962 @dots{}
5963 @}
5964 @end group
5965 @end example
5966
5967 @node VERSION
5968 @section VERSION Command
5969 @kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5970 @cindex symbol versions
5971 @cindex version script
5972 @cindex versions of symbols
5973 The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5974 only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5975 symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5976 a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5977 shared library.
5978
5979 You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5980 you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5981 also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5982
5983 The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5984 @smallexample
5985 VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5986 @end smallexample
5987
5988 The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5989 Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5990 version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5991 version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5992 version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5993 scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5994 library.
5995
5996 The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5997 examples.
5998
5999 @smallexample
6000 VERS_1.1 @{
6001 global:
6002 foo1;
6003 local:
6004 old*;
6005 original*;
6006 new*;
6007 @};
6008
6009 VERS_1.2 @{
6010 foo2;
6011 @} VERS_1.1;
6012
6013 VERS_2.0 @{
6014 bar1; bar2;
6015 extern "C++" @{
6016 ns::*;
6017 "f(int, double)";
6018 @};
6019 @} VERS_1.2;
6020 @end smallexample
6021
6022 This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6023 version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6024 The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6025 a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
6026 of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6027 symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6028 is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6029 in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
6030 However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6031 name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
6032
6033 Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6034 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6035 to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6036
6037 Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6038 depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6039 and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6040
6041 When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6042 specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6043 unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
6044 unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
6045 somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6046 wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6047 wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6048 set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6049 ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
6050
6051 The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6052 they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6053 could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6054 However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6055
6056 Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6057 in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6058 symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6059 won't.
6060
6061 @smallexample
6062 @{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
6063 @end smallexample
6064
6065 When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6066 symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6067 requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6068 shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6069 loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6070 linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6071 application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6072 way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6073 all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6074 search for each symbol reference.
6075
6076 The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6077 doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6078 that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6079 functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6080 the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6081 required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6082 that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6083 versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6084 the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6085
6086 There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6087 first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6088 source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6089 script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6090 maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6091 @smallexample
6092 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6093 @end smallexample
6094 @noindent
6095 in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6096 be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6097 The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
6098 @samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6099 takes precedence over a version script.
6100
6101 The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6102 function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6103 an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6104 version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6105 linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6106
6107 To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6108 source file. Here is an example:
6109
6110 @smallexample
6111 __asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6112 __asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6113 __asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6114 __asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6115 @end smallexample
6116
6117 In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6118 unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6119 example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6120 @samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6121
6122 When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6123 some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6124 this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6125 @samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6126 declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6127 you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6128
6129 If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6130 within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
6131 (i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
6132 specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6133
6134 You can also specify the language in the version script:
6135
6136 @smallexample
6137 VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6138 @end smallexample
6139
6140 The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
6141 The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6142 demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
6143 patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6144 @samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
6145
6146 Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6147 described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6148 or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6149 the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6150 whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6151 cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6152 might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6153 should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6154 expect when you upgrade.
6155
6156 @node Expressions
6157 @section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6158 @cindex expressions
6159 @cindex arithmetic
6160 The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6161 that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6162 expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6163 host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6164
6165 You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6166
6167 The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6168 expressions.
6169
6170 @menu
6171 * Constants:: Constants
6172 * Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
6173 * Symbols:: Symbol Names
6174 * Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
6175 * Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6176 * Operators:: Operators
6177 * Evaluation:: Evaluation
6178 * Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6179 * Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6180 @end menu
6181
6182 @node Constants
6183 @subsection Constants
6184 @cindex integer notation
6185 @cindex constants in linker scripts
6186 All constants are integers.
6187
6188 As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6189 octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
6190 hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
6191 @samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
6192 @samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6193 value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
6194
6195 @cindex scaled integers
6196 @cindex K and M integer suffixes
6197 @cindex M and K integer suffixes
6198 @cindex suffixes for integers
6199 @cindex integer suffixes
6200 In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6201 constant by
6202 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6203 @ifnottex
6204 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6205 @code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6206 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6207 @end ifnottex
6208 @tex
6209 ${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6210 @end tex
6211 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6212 respectively. For example, the following
6213 all refer to the same quantity:
6214
6215 @smallexample
6216 _fourk_1 = 4K;
6217 _fourk_2 = 4096;
6218 _fourk_3 = 0x1000;
6219 _fourk_4 = 10000o;
6220 @end smallexample
6221
6222 Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6223 conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6224
6225 @node Symbolic Constants
6226 @subsection Symbolic Constants
6227 @cindex symbolic constants
6228 @kindex CONSTANT
6229 It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
6230 the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6231
6232 @table @code
6233 @item MAXPAGESIZE
6234 @kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6235 The target's maximum page size.
6236
6237 @item COMMONPAGESIZE
6238 @kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6239 The target's default page size.
6240 @end table
6241
6242 So for example:
6243
6244 @smallexample
6245 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
6246 @end smallexample
6247
6248 will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6249 supported by the target.
6250
6251 @node Symbols
6252 @subsection Symbol Names
6253 @cindex symbol names
6254 @cindex names
6255 @cindex quoted symbol names
6256 @kindex "
6257 Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6258 and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6259 Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6260 specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6261 keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6262 @smallexample
6263 "SECTION" = 9;
6264 "with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
6265 @end smallexample
6266
6267 Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6268 to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6269 whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6270
6271 @node Orphan Sections
6272 @subsection Orphan Sections
6273 @cindex orphan
6274 Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6275 are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6276 script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
6277 output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6278 in which to place the orphaned input section.
6279
6280 If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6281 an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6282 placed at the end of that output section.
6283
6284 If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6285 sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6286 name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6287 orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6288 one new output section.
6289
6290 If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6291 then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
6292 in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6293 linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6294 attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6295 sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6296 support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
6297
6298 The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6299 (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
6300 output sections an orphan is placed in.
6301
6302 @node Location Counter
6303 @subsection The Location Counter
6304 @kindex .
6305 @cindex dot
6306 @cindex location counter
6307 @cindex current output location
6308 The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6309 current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6310 location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6311 within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6312 anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6313
6314 @cindex holes
6315 Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6316 moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
6317 location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6318 and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6319 doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
6320
6321 @smallexample
6322 SECTIONS
6323 @{
6324 output :
6325 @{
6326 file1(.text)
6327 . = . + 1000;
6328 file2(.text)
6329 . += 1000;
6330 file3(.text)
6331 @} = 0x12345678;
6332 @}
6333 @end smallexample
6334 @noindent
6335 In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6336 located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6337 followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6338 @file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
6339 @samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
6340 specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6341
6342 @cindex dot inside sections
6343 Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6344 current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
6345 statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
6346 absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6347 however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6348 not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6349
6350 @smallexample
6351 SECTIONS
6352 @{
6353 . = 0x100
6354 .text: @{
6355 *(.text)
6356 . = 0x200
6357 @}
6358 . = 0x500
6359 .data: @{
6360 *(.data)
6361 . += 0x600
6362 @}
6363 @}
6364 @end smallexample
6365
6366 The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6367 and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6368 the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6369 much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6370 move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6371 and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6372 the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6373 the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6374
6375 @cindex dot outside sections
6376 Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6377 output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6378 needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6379
6380 @smallexample
6381 SECTIONS
6382 @{
6383 start_of_text = . ;
6384 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6385 end_of_text = . ;
6386
6387 start_of_data = . ;
6388 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6389 end_of_data = . ;
6390 @}
6391 @end smallexample
6392
6393 If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6394 not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6395 between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6396 should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6397 blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6398 the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6399 sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6400 statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6401 special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6402 place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6403 as follows:
6404
6405 @smallexample
6406 SECTIONS
6407 @{
6408 start_of_text = . ;
6409 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6410 end_of_text = . ;
6411
6412 start_of_data = . ;
6413 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6414 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6415 end_of_data = . ;
6416 @}
6417 @end smallexample
6418
6419 This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6420 @code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6421 placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6422 assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6423 a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6424 section. So you could write:
6425
6426 @smallexample
6427 SECTIONS
6428 @{
6429 start_of_text = . ;
6430 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6431 end_of_text = . ;
6432
6433 . = . ;
6434 start_of_data = . ;
6435 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6436 end_of_data = . ;
6437 @}
6438 @end smallexample
6439
6440 Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6441 @code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6442
6443 @need 2000
6444 @node Operators
6445 @subsection Operators
6446 @cindex operators for arithmetic
6447 @cindex arithmetic operators
6448 @cindex precedence in expressions
6449 The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6450 the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6451 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6452 @ifnottex
6453 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6454 @smallexample
6455 precedence associativity Operators Notes
6456 (highest)
6457 1 left ! - ~ (1)
6458 2 left * / %
6459 3 left + -
6460 4 left >> <<
6461 5 left == != > < <= >=
6462 6 left &
6463 7 left |
6464 8 left &&
6465 9 left ||
6466 10 right ? :
6467 11 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6468 (lowest)
6469 @end smallexample
6470 Notes:
6471 (1) Prefix operators
6472 (2) @xref{Assignments}.
6473 @c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6474 @end ifnottex
6475 @tex
6476 \vskip \baselineskip
6477 %"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6478 \hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6479 \hrule
6480 \halign
6481 {\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6482 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6483 &Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6484 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6485 \noalign{\hrule}
6486 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6487 &highest&&&&&\cr
6488 % '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
6489 &1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
6490 &2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6491 &3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6492 &4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6493 &5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6494 &6&&left&&\&&\cr
6495 &7&&left&&|&\cr
6496 &8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6497 &9&&left&&||&\cr
6498 &10&&right&&? :&\cr
6499 &11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6500 &lowest&&&&&\cr
6501 height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6502 \hrule}
6503 @end tex
6504 @iftex
6505 {
6506 @obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6507 @dag@quad Prefix operators.
6508 @ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6509 }
6510 @end iftex
6511 @c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6512
6513 @node Evaluation
6514 @subsection Evaluation
6515 @cindex lazy evaluation
6516 @cindex expression evaluation order
6517 The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6518 an expression when absolutely necessary.
6519
6520 The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6521 address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6522 regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6523 as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6524
6525 However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6526 until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6527 other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6528 for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6529
6530 The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6531 assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6532 allocation.
6533
6534 Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6535 @samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6536
6537 If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6538 available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6539 following
6540 @smallexample
6541 @group
6542 SECTIONS
6543 @{
6544 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
6545 @{ *(.text) @}
6546 @}
6547 @end group
6548 @end smallexample
6549 @noindent
6550 will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6551 address}.
6552
6553 @node Expression Section
6554 @subsection The Section of an Expression
6555 @cindex expression sections
6556 @cindex absolute expressions
6557 @cindex relative expressions
6558 @cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6559 @cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6560 @cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
6561 Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6562 relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6563 using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6564 value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6565 symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6566 operations.
6567
6568 Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6569 section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6570 address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6571 @code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6572 functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
6573 One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6574 (@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
6575 differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6576 versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6577 section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6578 Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
6579 absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6580 given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6581 everywhere.
6582
6583 In the following simple example,
6584
6585 @smallexample
6586 @group
6587 SECTIONS
6588 @{
6589 . = 0x100;
6590 __executable_start = 0x100;
6591 .data :
6592 @{
6593 . = 0x10;
6594 __data_start = 0x10;
6595 *(.data)
6596 @}
6597 @dots{}
6598 @}
6599 @end group
6600 @end smallexample
6601
6602 both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6603 address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6604 @code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6605 section in the second two assignments.
6606
6607 For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6608 addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
6609
6610 @itemize @bullet
6611 @item
6612 Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6613 operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6614 absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6615 @item
6616 Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6617 relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6618 and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6619 @item
6620 Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6621 in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6622 address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6623 before applying the operator.
6624 @end itemize
6625
6626 The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6627
6628 @itemize @bullet
6629 @item
6630 An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6631 @item
6632 The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6633 @item
6634 The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
6635 relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
6636 (after above conversions) is also a number when
6637 @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6638 but an absolute address otherwise.
6639 @item
6640 The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6641 relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6642 section as the relative operand(s).
6643 @item
6644 The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6645 conversions) is an absolute address.
6646 @end itemize
6647
6648 You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6649 to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6650 create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6651 section @samp{.data}:
6652 @smallexample
6653 SECTIONS
6654 @{
6655 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6656 @}
6657 @end smallexample
6658 @noindent
6659 If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6660 @samp{.data} section.
6661
6662 Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6663 particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6664
6665 @node Builtin Functions
6666 @subsection Builtin Functions
6667 @cindex functions in expressions
6668 The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6669 use in linker script expressions.
6670
6671 @table @code
6672 @item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6673 @kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6674 @cindex expression, absolute
6675 Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6676 of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6677 value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6678 normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6679
6680 @item ADDR(@var{section})
6681 @kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6682 @cindex section address in expression
6683 Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
6684 script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
6685 the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6686 @code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6687 @code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6688 the other two will be absolute:
6689 @smallexample
6690 @group
6691 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6692 .output1 :
6693 @{
6694 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6695 @dots{}
6696 @}
6697 .output :
6698 @{
6699 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6700 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6701 @}
6702 @dots{} @}
6703 @end group
6704 @end smallexample
6705
6706 @item ALIGN(@var{align})
6707 @itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6708 @kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6709 @kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6710 @cindex round up location counter
6711 @cindex align location counter
6712 @cindex round up expression
6713 @cindex align expression
6714 Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6715 to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6716 doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6717 arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6718 expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
6719 equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
6720
6721 Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6722 next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6723 variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6724 input sections:
6725 @smallexample
6726 @group
6727 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6728 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6729 *(.data)
6730 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6731 @}
6732 @dots{} @}
6733 @end group
6734 @end smallexample
6735 @noindent
6736 The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6737 a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6738 a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6739 of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6740
6741 The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6742
6743 @item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6744 @kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6745 @cindex section alignment
6746 Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6747 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6748 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6749 the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6750 value in that section.
6751 @smallexample
6752 @group
6753 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6754 .output @{
6755 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6756 @dots{}
6757 @}
6758 @dots{} @}
6759 @end group
6760 @end smallexample
6761
6762 @item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6763 @kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6764 This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6765 scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6766 section.
6767
6768 @item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6769 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6770 This is equivalent to either
6771 @smallexample
6772 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6773 @end smallexample
6774 or
6775 @smallexample
6776 (ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6777 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
6778 @end smallexample
6779 @noindent
6780 depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6781 for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6782 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6783 If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6784 memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6785 bytes in the on-disk file.
6786
6787 This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6788 any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6789 @var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
6790 be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6791 running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6792 that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6793 page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
6794
6795 @noindent
6796 Example:
6797 @smallexample
6798 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6799 @end smallexample
6800
6801 @item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6802 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6803 This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6804 evaluation purposes.
6805
6806 @smallexample
6807 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6808 @end smallexample
6809
6810 @item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6811 @kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6812 This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
6813 @samp{-z relro} option is used.
6814 When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6815 does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
6816 @var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6817 argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6818 script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
6819 @code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6820 padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6821 section alignment.
6822
6823 @smallexample
6824 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6825 @end smallexample
6826
6827 @item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6828 @kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6829 @cindex symbol defaults
6830 Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
6831 defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6832 return 0. You can use this function to provide
6833 default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6834 shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6835 the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6836 existed, its value is preserved:
6837
6838 @smallexample
6839 @group
6840 SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6841 .text : @{
6842 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6843 @dots{}
6844 @}
6845 @dots{}
6846 @}
6847 @end group
6848 @end smallexample
6849
6850 @item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6851 @kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6852 Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6853
6854 @item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6855 @kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6856 @cindex section load address in expression
6857 Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
6858 Section LMA}).
6859
6860 @item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6861 @kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6862 Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6863 @code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6864
6865 @kindex MAX
6866 @item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6867 Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6868
6869 @kindex MIN
6870 @item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6871 Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6872
6873 @item NEXT(@var{exp})
6874 @kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6875 @cindex unallocated address, next
6876 Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6877 This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6878 use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6879 output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6880
6881 @item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6882 @kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6883 Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6884
6885 @item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6886 @kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6887 Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
6888 value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6889 @samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6890 will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6891 can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
6892 ``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
6893 name.
6894
6895 @item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6896 @kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6897 @cindex section size
6898 Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6899 been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6900 evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6901 @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6902 @smallexample
6903 @group
6904 SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6905 .output @{
6906 .start = . ;
6907 @dots{}
6908 .end = . ;
6909 @}
6910 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6911 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6912 @dots{} @}
6913 @end group
6914 @end smallexample
6915
6916 @item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6917 @itemx sizeof_headers
6918 @kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6919 @cindex header size
6920 Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6921 information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6922 this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6923 choose, to facilitate paging.
6924
6925 @cindex not enough room for program headers
6926 @cindex program headers, not enough room
6927 When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6928 @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6929 number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6930 addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6931 additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6932 room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6933 the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6934 script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6935 you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6936 command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6937 @end table
6938
6939 @node Implicit Linker Scripts
6940 @section Implicit Linker Scripts
6941 @cindex implicit linker scripts
6942 If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6943 an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6944 linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6945 linker will report an error.
6946
6947 An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6948
6949 Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6950 assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6951 commands.
6952
6953 Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6954 at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6955 read. This can affect archive searching.
6956
6957 @ifset GENERIC
6958 @node Machine Dependent
6959 @chapter Machine Dependent Features
6960
6961 @cindex machine dependencies
6962 @command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6963 sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
6964 functionality are not listed.
6965
6966 @menu
6967 @ifset H8300
6968 * H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6969 @end ifset
6970 @ifset M68HC11
6971 * M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6972 @end ifset
6973 @ifset ARM
6974 * ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6975 @end ifset
6976 @ifset HPPA
6977 * HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6978 @end ifset
6979 @ifset M68K
6980 * M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6981 @end ifset
6982 @ifset MIPS
6983 * MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6984 @end ifset
6985 @ifset MMIX
6986 * MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
6987 @end ifset
6988 @ifset MSP430
6989 * MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
6990 @end ifset
6991 @ifset NDS32
6992 * NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6993 @end ifset
6994 @ifset NIOSII
6995 * Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6996 @end ifset
6997 @ifset POWERPC
6998 * PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6999 @end ifset
7000 @ifset POWERPC64
7001 * PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7002 @end ifset
7003 @ifset S/390
7004 * S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7005 @end ifset
7006 @ifset SPU
7007 * SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7008 @end ifset
7009 @ifset TICOFF
7010 * TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
7011 @end ifset
7012 @ifset WIN32
7013 * WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7014 @end ifset
7015 @ifset XTENSA
7016 * Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7017 @end ifset
7018 @end menu
7019 @end ifset
7020
7021 @ifset H8300
7022 @ifclear GENERIC
7023 @raisesections
7024 @end ifclear
7025
7026 @node H8/300
7027 @section @command{ld} and the H8/300
7028
7029 @cindex H8/300 support
7030 For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
7031 you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7032
7033 @table @emph
7034 @cindex relaxing on H8/300
7035 @item relaxing address modes
7036 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7037 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7038 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7039 respectively.
7040
7041 @cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7042 @item synthesizing instructions
7043 @c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
7044 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
7045 sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7046 page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7047 (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7048 @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7049 top page of memory).
7050
7051 @command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7052 indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7053 displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7054 the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7055 @code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7056 whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7057 range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7058
7059 @item bit manipulation instructions
7060 @command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
7061 biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
7062 which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7063 page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7064 (That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
7065 @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7066 the top page of memory).
7067
7068 @item system control instructions
7069 @command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
7070 32 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
7071 changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7072 (That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
7073 @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
7074 the top page of memory).
7075 @end table
7076
7077 @ifclear GENERIC
7078 @lowersections
7079 @end ifclear
7080 @end ifset
7081
7082 @ifclear GENERIC
7083 @ifset Renesas
7084 @c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
7085 @c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7086 @node Renesas
7087 @chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
7088
7089 @command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7090 H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7091 options are required for these chips.
7092 @end ifset
7093 @end ifclear
7094
7095 @ifset ARM
7096 @ifclear GENERIC
7097 @raisesections
7098 @end ifclear
7099
7100 @ifset M68HC11
7101 @ifclear GENERIC
7102 @raisesections
7103 @end ifclear
7104
7105 @node M68HC11/68HC12
7106 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7107
7108 @cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7109
7110 @subsection Linker Relaxation
7111
7112 For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7113 optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7114
7115 @table @emph
7116 @cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7117 @item relaxing address modes
7118 @command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7119 targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7120 program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7121 respectively.
7122
7123 @command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7124 transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7125 page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7126
7127 @item relaxing gcc instruction group
7128 When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7129 of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7130 addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7131 @code{bset} instructions.
7132
7133 @end table
7134
7135 @subsection Trampoline Generation
7136
7137 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7138 @cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7139 For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7140 call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
7141 will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
7142 trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7143 case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7144 point to the function trampoline.
7145
7146 @ifclear GENERIC
7147 @lowersections
7148 @end ifclear
7149 @end ifset
7150
7151 @node ARM
7152 @section @command{ld} and the ARM family
7153
7154 @cindex ARM interworking support
7155 @kindex --support-old-code
7156 For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
7157 between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
7158 been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7159 line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7160 libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
7161 option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
7162 given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7163 which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7164 the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7165 non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7166
7167 @cindex thumb entry point
7168 @cindex entry point, thumb
7169 @kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7170 The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7171 @samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7172 But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7173 branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7174 executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7175
7176 @cindex PE import table prefixing
7177 @kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7178 The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7179 the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
7180 element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
7181 import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7182
7183 @cindex BE8
7184 @kindex --be8
7185 The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
7186 executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7187 objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7188 option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7189 little-endian code.
7190
7191 @cindex TARGET1
7192 @kindex --target1-rel
7193 @kindex --target1-abs
7194 The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7195 @samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7196 or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7197 and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7198
7199 @cindex TARGET2
7200 @kindex --target2=@var{type}
7201 The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7202 @samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7203 meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7204 @table @samp
7205 @item rel
7206 @samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7207 @item abs
7208 @samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
7209 @item got-rel
7210 @samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7211 @end table
7212
7213 @cindex FIX_V4BX
7214 @kindex --fix-v4bx
7215 The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7216 specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7217 interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7218 also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7219
7220 In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7221 linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7222 @code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7223
7224 In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7225 relocations are ignored.
7226
7227 @cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7228 @kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7229 Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7230 relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7231
7232 @smallexample
7233 TST rM, #1
7234 MOVEQ PC, rM
7235 BX Rn
7236 @end smallexample
7237
7238 This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7239 and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
7240 condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
7241
7242 @cindex USE_BLX
7243 @kindex --use-blx
7244 The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7245 BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7246 situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7247 code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7248 each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7249
7250 This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7251 specify it if you are using that target.
7252
7253 @cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7254 @kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7255 The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7256 bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7257 instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7258 to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7259 the support code can read the intended values.
7260
7261 The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7262 intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7263 and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7264 intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7265 full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7266 you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7267
7268 If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7269 enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7270 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7271 mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7272 vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7273 @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7274
7275 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7276 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7277 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7278 first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7279 instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7280 the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7281 are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7282
7283 @cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7284 @kindex --fix-arm1176
7285 @kindex --no-fix-arm1176
7286 The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7287 in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7288 are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
7289 unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7290
7291 Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
7292 Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
7293 http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7294
7295 @cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7296 @kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7297
7298 The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7299 workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7300 the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7301 off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7302 the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7303 core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7304 integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7305 VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7306
7307 The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7308 necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7309
7310 The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7311 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7312 STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7313 linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7314 @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7315
7316 If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7317 potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7318 such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7319 replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7320 branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7321 then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7322
7323 The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7324 the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7325
7326 The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7327 they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7328 there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7329 occurs.
7330
7331 The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7332 PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7333 large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7334 cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7335 occurs.
7336
7337 @cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7338 @kindex --no-enum-size-warning
7339 The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7340 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7341 enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7342 linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7343 using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7344 not be diagnosed.
7345
7346 @cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7347 @kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7348 The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7349 warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7350 @code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7351 linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7352 using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
7353
7354 @cindex PIC_VENEER
7355 @kindex --pic-veneer
7356 The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7357 ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7358 is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7359 @samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7360
7361 @cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7362 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7363 The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7364 code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7365 perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7366 placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
7367 controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
7368 The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
7369 duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
7370 group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7371 code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7372 where they should be placed.
7373
7374 The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7375 @option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
7376 placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
7377 branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7378 placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7379 value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7380 exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7381 A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7382 linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7383 from the input sections.
7384
7385 The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7386 @samp{N = +1}.
7387
7388 Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7389 only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7390 otherwise.
7391
7392 @cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7393 @kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7394 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7395 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7396
7397 The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7398
7399 @cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7400 @kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7401 @kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7402 The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7403
7404 Please contact ARM for further details.
7405
7406 @kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7407 @kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7408 @cindex Merging exidx entries
7409 The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7410
7411 @kindex --long-plt
7412 @cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7413 The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7414 which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7415 entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7416
7417 @kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7418 @cindex AArch64 rela addend
7419 The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7420 link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7421
7422 @cindex Placement of SG veneers
7423 All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
7424 Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
7425 @samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7426 veneers in memory.
7427
7428 @kindex --cmse-implib
7429 @cindex Secure gateway import library
7430 The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7431 specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7432 secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7433 executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7434
7435 @kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7436 @cindex Input import library
7437 The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7438 must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7439 given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7440 in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7441 @samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7442 library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7443 library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7444 for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7445 specified.
7446
7447 @ifclear GENERIC
7448 @lowersections
7449 @end ifclear
7450 @end ifset
7451
7452 @ifset HPPA
7453 @ifclear GENERIC
7454 @raisesections
7455 @end ifclear
7456
7457 @node HPPA ELF32
7458 @section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7459 @cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7460 @kindex --multi-subspace
7461 When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7462 import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7463 The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7464 stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7465 multiple sub-spaces.
7466
7467 @cindex HPPA stub grouping
7468 @kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7469 Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7470 stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7471 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7472 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7473 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7474 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7475 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7476 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7477 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7478 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7479 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7480 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7481 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7482 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7483
7484 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7485 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7486 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7487 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7488
7489 @ifclear GENERIC
7490 @lowersections
7491 @end ifclear
7492 @end ifset
7493
7494 @ifset M68K
7495 @ifclear GENERIC
7496 @raisesections
7497 @end ifclear
7498
7499 @node M68K
7500 @section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7501
7502 @cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7503 @kindex --got=@var{type}
7504 The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7505 The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7506 @samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7507 the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7508 @samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7509 entries only at non-negative offsets.
7510 @samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7511 entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7512 support such GOTs.
7513 @samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7514 output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7515 file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7516 files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7517
7518 @ifclear GENERIC
7519 @lowersections
7520 @end ifclear
7521 @end ifset
7522
7523 @ifset MIPS
7524 @ifclear GENERIC
7525 @raisesections
7526 @end ifclear
7527
7528 @node MIPS
7529 @section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7530
7531 @cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7532 @kindex --insn32
7533 @kindex --no-insn32
7534 The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7535 microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7536 in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7537 used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7538 or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7539 including 16-bit ones where possible.
7540
7541 @cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7542 @kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7543 @kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7544 The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7545 control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7546 @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7547 relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7548 calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7549 relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7550 instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7551 or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7552 the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7553
7554 @ifclear GENERIC
7555 @lowersections
7556 @end ifclear
7557 @end ifset
7558
7559 @ifset MMIX
7560 @ifclear GENERIC
7561 @raisesections
7562 @end ifclear
7563
7564 @node MMIX
7565 @section @code{ld} and MMIX
7566 For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7567 @code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7568 understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7569 can translate between the two formats.
7570
7571 There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7572 Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7573 registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7574 equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7575 @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7576 global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7577 this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7578 symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7579
7580 Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7581 @code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7582 The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7583 of a section.
7584
7585 Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7586 are left out from an mmo file.
7587
7588 @ifclear GENERIC
7589 @lowersections
7590 @end ifclear
7591 @end ifset
7592
7593 @ifset MSP430
7594 @ifclear GENERIC
7595 @raisesections
7596 @end ifclear
7597
7598 @node MSP430
7599 @section @code{ld} and MSP430
7600 For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7601 will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7602 just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7603
7604 @cindex MSP430 extra sections
7605 The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7606
7607 @table @code
7608 @item @samp{.vectors}
7609 Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7610
7611 @item @samp{.bootloader}
7612 Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7613 in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7614
7615 @item @samp{.infomem}
7616 Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7617 this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7618
7619 @item @samp{.infomemnobits}
7620 This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7621 in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7622
7623 @item @samp{.noinit}
7624 Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7625
7626 The last two sections are used by gcc.
7627 @end table
7628
7629 @table @option
7630 @cindex MSP430 Options
7631 @kindex --code-region
7632 @item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7633 This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7634 argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7635 using this option.
7636
7637 @kindex --data-region
7638 @item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7639 This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7640 [either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7641 for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7642
7643 @kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7644 @item --disable-sec-transformation
7645 Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7646 and @code{--data-region} options.
7647 This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7648 wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7649 not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7650 @end table
7651
7652 @ifclear GENERIC
7653 @lowersections
7654 @end ifclear
7655 @end ifset
7656
7657 @ifset NDS32
7658 @ifclear GENERIC
7659 @raisesections
7660 @end ifclear
7661
7662 @node NDS32
7663 @section @code{ld} and NDS32
7664 @kindex relaxing on NDS32
7665 For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7666 relaxes objects according to these options.
7667
7668 @table @code
7669 @item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7670 Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7671
7672 @item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7673 Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7674
7675 @item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7676 Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7677
7678 @item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7679 Export the EX9 table after linking.
7680
7681 @item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7682 Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7683
7684 @item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7685 Update the existing EX9 table.
7686
7687 @item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7688 Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7689
7690 @item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7691 Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7692
7693 @item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7694 Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7695
7696 @item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7697 Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7698 @end table
7699
7700 @ifclear GENERIC
7701 @lowersections
7702 @end ifclear
7703 @end ifset
7704
7705 @ifset NIOSII
7706 @ifclear GENERIC
7707 @raisesections
7708 @end ifclear
7709
7710 @node Nios II
7711 @section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7712 @cindex Nios II call relaxation
7713 @kindex --relax on Nios II
7714
7715 Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7716 transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7717 which may result in @command{ld} giving
7718 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7719 The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7720 trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7721 outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7722 trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7723 be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7724 larger than 256MB.
7725
7726 The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7727 is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7728 @option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7729 locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7730 source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7731 register as a temporary.
7732
7733 Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7734 relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7735 option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7736
7737 @ifclear GENERIC
7738 @lowersections
7739 @end ifclear
7740 @end ifset
7741
7742 @ifset POWERPC
7743 @ifclear GENERIC
7744 @raisesections
7745 @end ifclear
7746
7747 @node PowerPC ELF32
7748 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7749 @cindex PowerPC long branches
7750 @kindex --relax on PowerPC
7751 Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7752 displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7753 @samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7754 @samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7755 the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7756 section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
7757 section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7758 @samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7759 both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7760 considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
7761
7762 @cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7763 @table @option
7764 @cindex PowerPC PLT
7765 @kindex --bss-plt
7766 @item --bss-plt
7767 Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7768 generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7769 the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7770 writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7771 @command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7772 PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7773 compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7774 BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7775
7776 @kindex --secure-plt
7777 @item --secure-plt
7778 @command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7779 @samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7780 when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7781 layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7782 style BSS PLT.
7783
7784 @cindex PowerPC GOT
7785 @kindex --sdata-got
7786 @item --sdata-got
7787 The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7788 sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7789 @code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7790 section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7791 @code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7792 @code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7793 @samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7794 @code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7795 PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7796 pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7797 GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7798 really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7799
7800 @cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7801 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7802 @item --emit-stub-syms
7803 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7804 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7805
7806 @cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7807 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7808 @item --no-tls-optimize
7809 PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7810 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7811 disable the optimization.
7812 @end table
7813
7814 @ifclear GENERIC
7815 @lowersections
7816 @end ifclear
7817 @end ifset
7818
7819 @ifset POWERPC64
7820 @ifclear GENERIC
7821 @raisesections
7822 @end ifclear
7823
7824 @node PowerPC64 ELF64
7825 @section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7826
7827 @cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7828 @table @option
7829 @cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7830 @kindex --stub-group-size
7831 @item --stub-group-size
7832 Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7833 by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7834 @samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7835 sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7836 a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7837 the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7838 conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7839 prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7840 A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7841 branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7842 @samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7843 @command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7844 detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7845 positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7846
7847 Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7848 single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7849 create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7850 large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7851
7852 @cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7853 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
7854 @item --emit-stub-syms
7855 This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7856 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7857
7858 @cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7859 @kindex --dotsyms
7860 @kindex --no-dotsyms
7861 @item --dotsyms
7862 @itemx --no-dotsyms
7863 These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7864 in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7865 function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7866 code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7867 properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7868 to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7869 @samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7870 dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7871 feature.
7872
7873 @cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7874 @kindex --save-restore-funcs
7875 @kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
7876 @item --save-restore-funcs
7877 @itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7878 These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7879 provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7880 @samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7881 function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7882 link.
7883
7884 @cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7885 @kindex --no-tls-optimize
7886 @item --no-tls-optimize
7887 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7888 sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7889 disable the optimization.
7890
7891 @cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7892 @kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7893 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
7894 @kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7895 @kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
7896 @item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7897 @itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
7898 These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7899 stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7900 an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7901 @code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
7902 stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7903 generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7904 __tls_get_addr_opt.
7905 Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7906 much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7907 an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7908 will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7909 @option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7910 and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7911 this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7912 Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
7913 @option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
7914 register saves.
7915
7916 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7917 @kindex --no-opd-optimize
7918 @item --no-opd-optimize
7919 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7920 corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
7921 the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
7922 Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7923
7924 @cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7925 @kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7926 @item --non-overlapping-opd
7927 Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7928 @code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7929 the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7930 entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7931
7932 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7933 @kindex --no-toc-optimize
7934 @item --no-toc-optimize
7935 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7936 entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7937 reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7938 marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7939 marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7940 relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7941 unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7942 reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7943 discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7944 reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7945 code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7946 optimization.
7947
7948 @cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
7949 @kindex --no-inline-optimize
7950 @item --no-inline-optimize
7951 PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
7952 marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
7953 @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
7954 a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
7955 locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
7956 disables that optimization.
7957
7958 @cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7959 @kindex --no-multi-toc
7960 @item --no-multi-toc
7961 If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7962 @code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7963 where TOC
7964 entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7965 total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7966 grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7967 TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7968 calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7969 help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
7970 64K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7971 Use this option to turn off this feature.
7972
7973 @cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7974 @kindex --no-toc-sort
7975 @item --no-toc-sort
7976 By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7977 happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7978 placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7979 with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7980 referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7981 @code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7982 results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7983 off this feature.
7984
7985 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7986 @kindex --plt-align
7987 @kindex --no-plt-align
7988 @item --plt-align
7989 @itemx --no-plt-align
7990 Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
7991 aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7992 boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7993 specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7994 specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7995 if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7996 PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
7997
7998 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7999 @kindex --plt-static-chain
8000 @kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8001 @item --plt-static-chain
8002 @itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8003 Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8004 chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8005 chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8006
8007 @cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8008 @kindex --plt-thread-safe
8009 @kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8010 @item --plt-thread-safe
8011 @itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
8012 With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8013 lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8014 another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8015 order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8016 memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8017 barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8018 looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8019 seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8020 default behaviour.
8021
8022 @cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8023 @kindex --plt-localentry
8024 @kindex --no-plt-localentry
8025 @item --plt-localentry
8026 @itemx --no-localentry
8027 ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8028 ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8029 (the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8030 Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8031 or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8032 functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8033 in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
8034 interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8035 including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8036 to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8037 complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8038 care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
8039
8040 @cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8041 @kindex --power10-stubs
8042 @kindex --no-power10-stubs
8043 @item --power10-stubs
8044 @itemx --no-power10-stubs
8045 When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8046 relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
8047 linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8048 for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8049 power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
8050 power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8051 allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
8052 @option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8053 auto mode.
8054 @end table
8055
8056 @ifclear GENERIC
8057 @lowersections
8058 @end ifclear
8059 @end ifset
8060
8061 @ifset S/390
8062 @ifclear GENERIC
8063 @raisesections
8064 @end ifclear
8065
8066 @node S/390 ELF
8067 @section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8068
8069 @cindex S/390 ELF options
8070 @table @option
8071
8072 @cindex S/390
8073 @kindex --s390-pgste
8074 @item --s390-pgste
8075 This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8076 segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8077 binaries marked that way.
8078 @end table
8079
8080 @ifclear GENERIC
8081 @lowersections
8082 @end ifclear
8083 @end ifset
8084
8085 @ifset SPU
8086 @ifclear GENERIC
8087 @raisesections
8088 @end ifclear
8089
8090 @node SPU ELF
8091 @section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8092
8093 @cindex SPU ELF options
8094 @table @option
8095
8096 @cindex SPU plugins
8097 @kindex --plugin
8098 @item --plugin
8099 This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8100
8101 @cindex SPU overlays
8102 @kindex --no-overlays
8103 @item --no-overlays
8104 Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8105 regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8106 @command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8107 turns off all this special overlay handling.
8108
8109 @cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8110 @kindex --emit-stub-syms
8111 @item --emit-stub-syms
8112 This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8113 symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8114
8115 @cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8116 @kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8117 @item --extra-overlay-stubs
8118 This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8119 function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8120 on calls to non-overlay regions.
8121
8122 @cindex SPU local store size
8123 @kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8124 @item --local-store=lo:hi
8125 @command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8126 the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8127 range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8128
8129 @cindex SPU
8130 @kindex --stack-analysis
8131 @item --stack-analysis
8132 SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8133 unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8134 under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8135 @command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8136 @command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8137 determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8138 for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8139 for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8140 for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8141 find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8142 and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8143 under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8144 dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8145 is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8146 and calls will be given.
8147
8148 @cindex SPU
8149 @kindex --emit-stack-syms
8150 @item --emit-stack-syms
8151 This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8152 in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8153 These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8154 functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8155 functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8156 such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8157 The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
8158 @code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
8159 @end table
8160
8161 @ifclear GENERIC
8162 @lowersections
8163 @end ifclear
8164 @end ifset
8165
8166 @ifset TICOFF
8167 @ifclear GENERIC
8168 @raisesections
8169 @end ifclear
8170
8171 @node TI COFF
8172 @section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8173 @cindex TI COFF versions
8174 @kindex --format=@var{version}
8175 The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8176 TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8177 also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8178 format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8179 header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8180
8181 @ifclear GENERIC
8182 @lowersections
8183 @end ifclear
8184 @end ifset
8185
8186 @ifset WIN32
8187 @ifclear GENERIC
8188 @raisesections
8189 @end ifclear
8190
8191 @node WIN32
8192 @section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8193
8194 This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
8195 See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8196 command-line options mentioned here.
8197
8198 @table @emph
8199 @cindex import libraries
8200 @item import libraries
8201 The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
8202 libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
8203 regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8204 archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
8205 support for creating such libraries provided with the
8206 @samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
8207
8208 @item exporting DLL symbols
8209 @cindex exporting DLL symbols
8210 The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8211
8212 @table @emph
8213 @item using auto-export functionality
8214 @cindex using auto-export functionality
8215 By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
8216 which is controlled by the following command-line options:
8217
8218 @itemize
8219 @item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8220 @item --exclude-symbols
8221 @item --exclude-libs
8222 @item --exclude-modules-for-implib
8223 @item --version-script
8224 @end itemize
8225
8226 When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8227 (global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8228 symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8229 often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8230 private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
8231 options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
8232 exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8233 final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8234
8235 If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
8236 command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8237 if either of the following are true:
8238
8239 @itemize
8240 @item A DEF file is used.
8241 @item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8242 @end itemize
8243
8244 @item using a DEF file
8245 @cindex using a DEF file
8246 Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8247 an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8248 exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8249 name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
8250 command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
8251
8252 @example
8253 gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8254 @end example
8255
8256 Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8257 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8258
8259 Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8260
8261 @example
8262 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
8263
8264 EXPORTS
8265 foo
8266 bar
8267 _bar = bar
8268 another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8269 var1 DATA
8270 doo = foo == foo2
8271 eoo DATA == var1
8272 @end example
8273
8274 This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
8275 symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8276 alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8277 by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8278 @code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
8279 @code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8280 export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8281 in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8282 symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
8283
8284 The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8285 name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8286 the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8287
8288 When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8289 library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
8290 @code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
8291 executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
8292
8293 With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8294 specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
8295 non-default base address for the image.
8296
8297 If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
8298 or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8299 filename specified on the command line.
8300
8301 The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8302
8303 @example
8304 EXPORTS
8305 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8306 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
8307 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
8308 @end example
8309
8310 Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8311 @samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8312 @samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8313 @samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8314 Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
8315 @samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8316 string in import/export table for the symbol.
8317
8318 The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8319
8320 @code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8321 will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8322 by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8323 linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8324 library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8325
8326 @code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8327 The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8328 the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8329 @code{*_imp__foo}).
8330
8331 @code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8332 well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8333 read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8334 variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8335 the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8336 extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8337 application will behave unexpectedly.
8338
8339 @code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8340 it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8341 symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
8342 API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
8343 the DLL without an import library.
8344
8345 See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8346 other DEF file statements
8347
8348 @cindex creating a DEF file
8349 While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
8350 with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
8351
8352 @item Using decorations
8353 @cindex Using decorations
8354 Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8355 itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8356 declared as:
8357
8358 @example
8359 __declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8360 __declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8361 @end example
8362
8363 All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8364 any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8365 this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8366 the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8367
8368 Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
8369 decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
8370 instead:
8371
8372 @example
8373 __declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8374 __declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8375 @end example
8376
8377 This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8378 when included by the library itself the header must declare the
8379 variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8380 code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
8381 of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
8382 omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8383 @samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
8384 information.
8385 @end table
8386
8387 @cindex automatic data imports
8388 @item automatic data imports
8389 The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
8390 by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
8391 compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
8392 issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
8393 code to these platforms, especially for large
8394 c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
8395 initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
8396 decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
8397 platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
8398 command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8399 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8400 suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8401 trigger the feature's use.
8402
8403 auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
8404 additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8405
8406 "variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
8407 documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8408
8409 The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8410 occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8411 One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
8412 below.
8413
8414 @cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
8415 For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8416 object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8417 offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8418 field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8419 in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
8420 without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
8421 The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
8422 references.
8423
8424 The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8425 be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8426 themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8427 runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8428 compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8429 support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
8430 run without error on an older system.
8431
8432 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8433 enabled as needed.
8434
8435 @cindex direct linking to a dll
8436 @item direct linking to a dll
8437 The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8438 including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
8439 libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
8440 traditional import library method, especially when linking large
8441 libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8442 function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8443 though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
8444 storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
8445 tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
8446 large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8447
8448 Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
8449 @samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
8450 of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
8451 perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8452 select the dll instead of an import library.
8453
8454
8455 For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8456 to find, in the first directory of its search path,
8457
8458 @example
8459 libxxx.dll.a
8460 xxx.dll.a
8461 libxxx.a
8462 xxx.lib
8463 libxxx.lib
8464 cygxxx.dll (*)
8465 libxxx.dll
8466 xxx.dll
8467 @end example
8468
8469 before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8470
8471 (*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8472 where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8473 @samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8474 file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
8475 @samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8476
8477 Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8478 @samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
8479 was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8480 various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8481 could coexist on the same machine.
8482
8483 The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8484 applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
8485 libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
8486
8487 @example
8488 bin/
8489 cygxxx.dll
8490 lib/
8491 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
8492 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
8493 @end example
8494
8495 Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8496 done two ways:
8497
8498 1. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8499 @example
8500 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
8501 @end example
8502
8503 However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8504 (@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8505 @samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8506 not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8507
8508 2. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8509 directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8510 should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8511 making the app/dll.
8512
8513 @example
8514 ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
8515 @end example
8516
8517 Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8518
8519 @example
8520 gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
8521 @end example
8522
8523 This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8524 perfectly legal
8525
8526 @example
8527 bin/
8528 cygxxx-5.dll
8529 lib/
8530 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
8531 @end example
8532
8533 Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
8534 even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8535 @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8536
8537 Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
8538 wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
8539
8540 1. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8541 work with auto-imported data.
8542
8543 2. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8544 import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8545 symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8546 for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8547 possible to do this without an import lib.
8548
8549 3. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8550 critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8551 in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8552 stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8553
8554 So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
8555 true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8556 a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8557 binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
8558 massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8559 requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8560 will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
8561
8562 @item symbol aliasing
8563 @table @emph
8564 @item adding additional names
8565 Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
8566 A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8567 exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8568 when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
8569 import library. Consider the following DEF file:
8570
8571 @example
8572 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8573
8574 EXPORTS
8575 foo
8576 _foo = foo
8577 @end example
8578
8579 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8580
8581 Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8582 source code using the "weak" attribute:
8583
8584 @example
8585 void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
8586 void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
8587 @end example
8588
8589 See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8590 symbols.
8591
8592 @item renaming symbols
8593 Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
8594 kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
8595 @samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8596 DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
8597 created). In the following example:
8598
8599 @example
8600 LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8601
8602 EXPORTS
8603 _foo = foo
8604 @end example
8605
8606 The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8607 @samp{_foo}.
8608 @end table
8609
8610 Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
8611 unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
8612 If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
8613 @emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8614 that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8615 @samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8616 renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8617 to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8618 the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8619 In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
8620 which is probably not what you wanted.
8621
8622 @cindex weak externals
8623 @item weak externals
8624 The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8625 weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8626 defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8627 are three variants of weak externals:
8628 @itemize
8629 @item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8630 called lazy externals.
8631 @item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8632 This form is not presently implemented.
8633 @item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8634 implemented.
8635 @end itemize
8636 As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8637 are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8638 uses a default value.
8639
8640 @cindex aligned common symbols
8641 @item aligned common symbols
8642 As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8643 desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8644 the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8645 carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8646 by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8647 tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8648 but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8649 warnings about unknown linker directives.
8650
8651 @end table
8652
8653 @ifclear GENERIC
8654 @lowersections
8655 @end ifclear
8656 @end ifset
8657
8658 @ifset XTENSA
8659 @ifclear GENERIC
8660 @raisesections
8661 @end ifclear
8662
8663 @node Xtensa
8664 @section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8665
8666 @cindex Xtensa processors
8667 The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8668 @code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8669 specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8670 keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8671 example, with the command:
8672
8673 @smallexample
8674 SECTIONS
8675 @{
8676 .text : @{
8677 *(.literal .text)
8678 @}
8679 @}
8680 @end smallexample
8681
8682 @noindent
8683 @command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8684 and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8685 literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8686 interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8687 group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8688 files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8689 and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
8690
8691 @cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
8692 @cindex relaxing on Xtensa
8693 Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8694 provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8695 is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8696 literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8697 will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8698 location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8699 the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8700 unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8701 @code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8702 range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8703
8704 For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8705 to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8706 instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8707 instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8708 instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8709 @code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8710 hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8711 By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8712 switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8713 density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8714 instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8715 performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8716 linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8717 a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8718
8719 The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8720 control the linker:
8721
8722 @cindex Xtensa options
8723 @table @option
8724 @item --size-opt
8725 When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8726 more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8727 no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8728 alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8729 preserve the correctness of the code.
8730
8731 @item --abi-windowed
8732 @itemx --abi-call0
8733 Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8734 PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8735 because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8736 conventions.
8737 Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8738 of the first input object.
8739 A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8740 or the chosen output object ABI.
8741 @end table
8742
8743 @ifclear GENERIC
8744 @lowersections
8745 @end ifclear
8746 @end ifset
8747
8748 @ifclear SingleFormat
8749 @node BFD
8750 @chapter BFD
8751
8752 @cindex back end
8753 @cindex object file management
8754 @cindex object formats available
8755 @kindex objdump -i
8756 The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8757 These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8758 object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8759 format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8760 it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8761 associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8762 object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8763 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8764 list all the formats available for your configuration.
8765
8766 @cindex BFD requirements
8767 @cindex requirements for BFD
8768 As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8769 several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8770 BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8771 formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8772 been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8773 BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8774 may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8775
8776 One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8777 mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8778 useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8779 conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8780
8781 @menu
8782 * BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8783 @end menu
8784
8785 @node BFD outline
8786 @section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
8787 @cindex opening object files
8788 @include bfdsumm.texi
8789 @end ifclear
8790
8791 @node Reporting Bugs
8792 @chapter Reporting Bugs
8793 @cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8794 @cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
8795
8796 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
8797
8798 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8799 it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
8800 to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
8801 work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
8802 @command{ld}.
8803
8804 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8805 information that enables us to fix the bug.
8806
8807 @menu
8808 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8809 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8810 @end menu
8811
8812 @node Bug Criteria
8813 @section Have You Found a Bug?
8814 @cindex bug criteria
8815
8816 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8817
8818 @itemize @bullet
8819 @cindex fatal signal
8820 @cindex linker crash
8821 @cindex crash of linker
8822 @item
8823 If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
8824 @command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
8825
8826 @cindex error on valid input
8827 @item
8828 If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
8829
8830 @cindex invalid input
8831 @item
8832 If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
8833 may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8834 object files are correct.
8835
8836 @item
8837 If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
8838 improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
8839 @end itemize
8840
8841 @node Bug Reporting
8842 @section How to Report Bugs
8843 @cindex bug reports
8844 @cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
8845
8846 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
8847 products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
8848 recommend you contact that organization first.
8849
8850 You can find contact information for many support companies and
8851 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8852 distribution.
8853
8854 @ifset BUGURL
8855 Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
8856 @value{BUGURL}.
8857 @end ifset
8858
8859 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8860 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8861 fact or leave it out, state it!
8862
8863 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8864 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
8865 assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8866 matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8867 the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8868 location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8869 were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8870 into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8871 specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
8872 and the most helpful.
8873
8874 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8875 the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8876 on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
8877
8878 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
8879 bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8880 respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8881 You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
8882
8883 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8884
8885 @itemize @bullet
8886 @item
8887 The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
8888 the @samp{--version} argument.
8889
8890 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
8891 the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
8892
8893 @item
8894 Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
8895 patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8896
8897 @item
8898 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8899 version number.
8900
8901 @item
8902 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
8903 ``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8904
8905 @item
8906 The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8907 observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8908 list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8909 sufficient.
8910
8911 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8912 and then we might not encounter the bug.
8913
8914 @item
8915 A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
8916 bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8917 provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8918 bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8919 state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8920 requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8921 we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8922 attachments are best.
8923
8924 If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8925 @code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8926 object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8927 @code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8928 how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8929
8930 @item
8931 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8932 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8933
8934 Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
8935 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8936 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8937 a chance to make a mistake.
8938
8939 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8940 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
8941 copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
8942 C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8943 and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8944 fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8945 you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8946 any conclusion from our observations.
8947
8948 @item
8949 If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
8950 diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8951 @samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
8952 If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
8953 context, not by line number.
8954
8955 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8956 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8957 @end itemize
8958
8959 Here are some things that are not necessary:
8960
8961 @itemize @bullet
8962 @item
8963 A description of the envelope of the bug.
8964
8965 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8966 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8967 changes will not affect it.
8968
8969 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8970 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8971 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8972 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8973
8974 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8975 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8976 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8977 less time, and so on.
8978
8979 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8980 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8981
8982 @item
8983 A patch for the bug.
8984
8985 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8986 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8987 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8988 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8989
8990 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
8991 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8992 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8993 able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8994 fixed.
8995
8996 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8997 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8998 help us to understand.
8999
9000 @item
9001 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9002
9003 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9004 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9005 @end itemize
9006
9007 @node MRI
9008 @appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9009 @cindex MRI compatibility
9010 To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9011 linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
9012 alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9013 described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9014 simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
9015 @command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
9016 linker commands; these commands are described here.
9017
9018 In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9019 file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9020 features to make use of them.
9021
9022 You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9023 @samp{-c} command-line option.
9024
9025 Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9026 command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9027 blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
9028 MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
9029 issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9030
9031 Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9032
9033 You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9034 lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9035 The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9036
9037 @table @code
9038 @cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9039 @item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9040 @itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9041 Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
9042 the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9043 @code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9044 your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9045 script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9046 commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9047 input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9048 @code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9049
9050 @cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9051 @item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9052 Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9053 in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9054
9055 @var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9056
9057 @cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9058 @item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9059 Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9060 @var{expression} should be a power of two.
9061
9062 @cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9063 @item BASE @var{expression}
9064 Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9065 absolute addresses) in the output file.
9066
9067 @cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9068 @item CHIP @var{expression}
9069 @itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9070 This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9071
9072 @cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9073 @item END
9074 This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9075
9076 @cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9077 @item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9078 Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
9079 language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
9080
9081 @cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9082 @item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9083 Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
9084 @command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
9085
9086 The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9087 same line, with no change in its effect.
9088
9089 @cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9090 @item LOAD @var{filename}
9091 @itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9092 Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
9093 same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
9094 command line.
9095
9096 @cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9097 @item NAME @var{output-name}
9098 @var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
9099 MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9100 option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9101
9102 @cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9103 @item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9104 @itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
9105 Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
9106 order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9107 script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9108 sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9109 file, in the order specified.
9110
9111 @cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9112 @item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9113 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9114 @itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9115 Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9116 @var{name} used in the linker input files.
9117
9118 @cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9119 @item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9120 @itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9121 @itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9122 You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9123 specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9124 If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9125 @var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9126 @end table
9127
9128 @node GNU Free Documentation License
9129 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
9130 @include fdl.texi
9131
9132 @node LD Index
9133 @unnumbered LD Index
9134
9135 @printindex cp
9136
9137 @tex
9138 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
9139 % meantime:
9140 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9141 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9142 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9143 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9144 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9145 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9146 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9147 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9148 \page\colophon
9149 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
9150 @end tex
9151
9152 @bye